1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.80 2010/06/06 00:25:46 pdp Exp $
3 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
5 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
6 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
7 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
9 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
10 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
11 . unwanted vertical space.
12 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
19 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
25 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
26 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
28 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
34 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
35 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
41 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
47 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
48 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
50 .set previousversion "4.71"
53 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
54 .set I " "
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
59 . provided in the xfpt library.
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
67 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
70 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
72 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
73 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
74 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
85 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
89 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
90 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
91 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
94 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
97 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
98 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
99 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
103 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
115 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
116 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
117 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
118 . --- ID that ties them together.
121 &<indexterm role="concept">&
122 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
130 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
131 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
139 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
143 &<indexterm role="option">&
144 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
152 &<indexterm role="variable">&
153 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
161 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
173 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
174 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
175 <date>29 May 2010</date>
176 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
177 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
178 <revhistory><revision>
179 <revnumber>4.72</revnumber>
180 <date>29 May 2010</date>
181 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
182 </revision></revhistory>
183 <copyright><year>2009</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
189 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
190 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
191 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
194 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
197 <indexterm role="variable">
198 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
199 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
201 <indexterm role="concept">
202 <primary>address</primary>
203 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
204 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
206 <indexterm role="concept">
207 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
208 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>CR character</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CRL</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>delivery</primary>
224 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
225 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
227 <indexterm role="concept">
228 <primary>dialup</primary>
229 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>exiscan</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>failover</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>fallover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>filter</primary>
245 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
246 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
248 <indexterm role="concept">
249 <primary>ident</primary>
250 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>LF character</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>maximum</primary>
258 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>monitor</primary>
262 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
266 <see>entry for xxx</see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>NUL</primary>
270 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>passwd file</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>process id</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>RBL</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>redirection</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>return path</primary>
290 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>scanning</primary>
294 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>SSL</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>string</primary>
302 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
303 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
305 <indexterm role="concept">
306 <primary>top bit</primary>
307 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>variables</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
321 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
322 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
323 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
324 . chapter "Introduction"
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
327 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
328 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
329 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
330 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
332 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
333 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
334 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
335 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
336 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
337 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
338 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
340 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
341 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
342 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
344 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
345 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
346 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
348 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
349 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
350 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
351 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
352 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
354 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
355 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
356 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
357 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
358 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
360 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
361 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
362 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
363 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
367 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
368 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
370 .cindex "documentation"
371 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
372 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
373 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
374 capable of showing a change indicator.
377 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
378 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
379 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
380 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
381 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
382 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
383 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
386 .cindex "books about Exim"
387 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
388 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
389 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
390 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
392 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
393 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
394 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
395 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
397 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
398 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
399 Debian-specific features in the file
400 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
401 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
404 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
405 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
407 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
408 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
409 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
410 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
411 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
413 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
414 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
415 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
416 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
418 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
419 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
421 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
422 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
423 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
427 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
428 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
429 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
430 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
431 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
432 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
433 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
436 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
437 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
438 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
442 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
445 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
446 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
447 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
448 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
449 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
450 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
454 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
455 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
456 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
457 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
458 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
461 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
462 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
463 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
468 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
469 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
475 .row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
478 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
479 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
480 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
481 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
482 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
485 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
487 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
490 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
491 .cindex "training courses"
492 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
493 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
494 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
495 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
497 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
498 .cindex "bug reports"
499 .cindex "reporting bugs"
500 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
501 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
502 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
503 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
507 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
509 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
510 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
512 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
516 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
518 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
519 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
520 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
522 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
523 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
524 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
525 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
528 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
530 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
531 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
532 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
538 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
539 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
543 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
545 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
546 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
547 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
549 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
550 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
551 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
552 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
554 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
559 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
560 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
563 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
565 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
566 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
567 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
568 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
569 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
570 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
571 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
573 .cindex "domainless addresses"
574 .cindex "address" "without domain"
575 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
576 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
577 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
578 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
581 .cindex "transport" "external"
582 .cindex "external transports"
583 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
584 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
585 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
586 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
587 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
588 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
590 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
591 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
592 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
595 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
596 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
597 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
598 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
599 a number of common scanners are provided.
603 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
604 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
605 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
606 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
607 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
608 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
611 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
612 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
613 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
614 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
615 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
616 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
617 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
618 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
619 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
620 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
621 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
622 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
624 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
625 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
626 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
627 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
631 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
632 .cindex "terminology definitions"
633 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
634 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
635 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
636 below) by a blank line.
638 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
639 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
640 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
641 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
642 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
643 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
644 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
645 rise to further bounce messages.
647 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
648 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
649 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
652 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
653 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
654 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
657 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
658 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
659 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
661 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
662 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
663 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
664 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
665 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
666 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
667 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
668 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
670 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
671 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
672 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
673 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
674 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
675 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
678 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
679 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
680 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
681 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
682 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
684 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
685 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
686 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
687 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
688 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
689 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
691 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
692 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
695 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
696 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
697 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
698 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
699 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
701 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
702 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
703 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
704 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
705 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
707 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
708 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
709 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
710 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
711 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
712 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
722 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
723 .cindex "incorporated code"
724 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
726 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
729 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
730 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
731 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
732 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
733 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
734 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
736 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
737 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
738 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
739 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
740 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
741 following statements:
744 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
746 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
747 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
748 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
750 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
751 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
752 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
753 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
754 restrictions applied to it).
757 .cindex "SPA authentication"
758 .cindex "Samba project"
759 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
760 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
761 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
762 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
766 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
767 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
768 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
769 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
770 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
771 conditions expressed therein.
774 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
776 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
777 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
781 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
782 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
784 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
785 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
786 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
789 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
790 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
791 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
792 details, please contact
794 Office of Technology Transfer
795 Carnegie Mellon University
797 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
798 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
799 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
802 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
805 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
806 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
808 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
809 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
810 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
811 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
812 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
813 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
814 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
819 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
822 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
823 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
824 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
825 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
828 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
829 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
833 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
834 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
835 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
836 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
837 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
838 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
839 software without specific, written prior permission.
841 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
842 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
843 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
844 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
845 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
846 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
851 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
852 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
853 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
861 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
863 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
864 "Receiving and delivering mail"
867 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
868 .cindex "design philosophy"
869 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
870 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
871 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
872 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
873 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
874 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
877 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
878 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
879 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
880 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
881 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
882 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
883 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
886 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
887 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
888 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
889 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
890 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
891 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
892 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
893 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
894 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
897 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
898 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
900 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
901 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
902 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
903 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
905 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
906 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
907 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
908 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
909 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
911 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
912 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
913 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
915 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
916 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
917 runs at the start of every delivery process.
922 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
923 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
924 .cindex "Sieve filter"
925 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
926 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
927 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
928 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
929 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
930 of filtering are available:
933 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
936 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
937 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
940 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
944 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
945 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
946 .cindex "format" "of message id"
947 .cindex "id of message"
952 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
953 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
954 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
955 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
956 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
957 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
958 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
959 not always case-sensitive.
961 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
962 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
963 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
964 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
965 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
966 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
970 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
971 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
972 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
973 way of representing the date and time of day).
975 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
976 received the message.
978 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
980 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
981 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
982 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
983 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
984 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
986 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
987 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
992 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
993 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
994 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
995 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
996 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
999 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1000 .cindex "receiving mail"
1001 .cindex "message" "reception"
1002 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1003 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1004 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1005 there are several possibilities:
1008 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1009 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1010 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1012 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1013 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1014 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1015 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1016 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1017 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1019 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1020 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1021 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1022 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1023 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1025 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1026 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1027 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1028 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1032 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1033 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1034 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1035 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1036 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1037 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1038 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1039 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1040 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1041 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1042 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1043 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1044 users to change sender addresses.
1046 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1047 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1048 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1049 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1050 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1051 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1052 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1054 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1055 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1056 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1057 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1058 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1059 message is received.
1065 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1066 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1067 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1068 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1069 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1070 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1071 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1072 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1074 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1075 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1076 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1077 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1078 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1079 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1080 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1081 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1082 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1083 affect file system performance.
1085 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1086 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1087 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1088 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1089 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1091 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1092 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1093 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1094 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1095 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1096 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1097 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1098 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1099 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1100 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1101 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1102 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1106 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1107 .cindex "message" "life of"
1108 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1109 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1110 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1111 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1112 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1113 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1114 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1116 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1117 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1118 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1119 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1120 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1123 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1124 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1125 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1126 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1127 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1129 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1130 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1131 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1132 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1133 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1134 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1135 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1136 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1137 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1138 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1141 .cindex "journal file"
1142 .cindex "file" "journal"
1143 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1144 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1145 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1146 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1147 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1148 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1149 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1150 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1152 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1153 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1154 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1155 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1156 deliveries caused by crashes.
1160 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1161 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1163 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1164 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1165 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1166 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1167 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1168 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1170 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1171 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1172 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1173 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1174 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1175 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1176 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1177 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1178 the driver's features in general.
1180 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1181 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1182 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1183 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1186 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1187 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1188 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1189 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1190 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1191 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1193 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1194 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1195 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1196 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1197 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1198 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1200 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1201 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1202 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1205 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1206 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1207 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1208 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1209 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1210 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1211 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1212 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1213 configured to fail the address.
1215 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1216 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1217 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1218 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1219 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1220 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1222 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1223 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1224 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1225 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1226 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1227 the address is bounced.
1231 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1232 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1233 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1234 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1235 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1236 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1237 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1238 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1240 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1241 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1242 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1243 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1244 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1245 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1246 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1247 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1252 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1253 .cindex "router" "running details"
1254 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1255 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1256 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1257 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1258 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1259 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1263 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1264 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1265 original address ceases,
1266 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1267 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1268 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1269 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1270 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1273 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1274 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1275 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1276 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1277 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1279 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1280 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1281 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1282 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1283 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1285 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1286 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1287 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1288 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1289 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1291 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1292 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1293 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1295 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1296 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1297 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1298 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1300 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1301 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1304 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1305 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1306 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1307 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1308 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1310 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1311 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1312 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1313 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1314 facility for this purpose.
1317 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1318 .cindex "case of local parts"
1319 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1320 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1321 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1322 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1323 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1324 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1325 routed addresses are shown.
1329 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1330 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1331 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1332 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1333 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1334 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1337 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1338 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1339 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1340 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1341 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1342 of any other conditions.
1344 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1345 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1346 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1348 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1349 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1350 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1351 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1353 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1354 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1355 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1356 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1357 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1359 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1360 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1362 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1363 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1365 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1366 of domains that it defines.
1368 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1369 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1370 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1371 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1372 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1373 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1374 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1375 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1376 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1377 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1379 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1380 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1382 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1383 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1384 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1385 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1386 remaining preconditions.
1388 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1389 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1390 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1391 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1392 could lead to confusion.
1394 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1395 set of addresses that it defines.
1397 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1398 specified files is tested.
1400 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1401 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1402 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1403 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1407 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1408 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1409 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1410 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1411 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1412 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1413 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1417 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1418 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1419 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1422 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1423 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1424 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1425 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1426 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1428 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1429 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1431 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1432 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1433 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1434 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1435 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1436 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1439 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1440 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1441 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1442 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1443 processed entirely independently of each other.
1445 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1446 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1447 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1448 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1449 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1450 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1451 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1452 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1453 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1455 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1456 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1457 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1458 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1459 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1460 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1461 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1462 addresses to the same domain.
1464 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1465 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1466 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1467 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1468 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1469 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1470 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1471 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1473 .cindex "queue runner"
1474 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1475 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1476 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1477 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1478 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1479 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1480 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1481 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1482 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1484 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1485 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1486 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1487 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1488 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1489 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1491 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1492 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1493 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1494 messages to other addresses.
1496 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1497 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1498 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1501 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1502 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1503 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1509 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1510 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1511 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1512 .cindex "queue runner"
1513 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1514 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1515 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1516 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1517 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1518 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1519 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1520 passed its retry time.
1521 You can run several queue runners at once.
1523 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1524 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1525 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1526 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1527 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1532 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1533 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1534 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1535 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1536 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1537 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1538 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1539 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1540 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1543 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1544 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1545 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1548 .cindex "hints database"
1549 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1550 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1551 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1552 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1558 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1559 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1560 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1561 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1562 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1563 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1564 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1565 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1566 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1567 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1568 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1570 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1571 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1572 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1575 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1576 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1577 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1578 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1579 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1580 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1581 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1586 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1587 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1588 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1589 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1590 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1591 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1592 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1593 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1602 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1603 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1605 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1606 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1607 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1608 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1611 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1612 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1614 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1615 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1616 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1617 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1621 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1622 following subdirectories are created:
1625 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1626 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1627 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1628 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1629 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1630 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1631 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1634 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1635 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1636 that may be useful to some sites.
1639 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1640 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1641 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1642 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1643 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1644 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1646 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1647 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1648 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1649 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1650 overridden if necessary.
1653 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1654 .cindex "PCRE library"
1655 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1656 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1657 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1658 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1659 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1660 headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1661 and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1662 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1663 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1665 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1666 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1667 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1668 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1669 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1670 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1671 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1673 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1674 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1675 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1677 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1678 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1679 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1680 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1682 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1683 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1684 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1685 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1686 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1687 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1688 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1689 Berkeley DB library.
1691 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1692 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1696 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1697 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1699 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1700 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1701 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1702 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1703 file name is used unmodified.
1705 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1706 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1707 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1708 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1710 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1711 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1712 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1714 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1715 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1716 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1717 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1718 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1719 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1721 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1722 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1723 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1724 operates on a single file.
1728 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1729 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1730 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1731 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1732 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1736 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1737 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1739 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1740 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1741 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1742 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1743 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1744 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1746 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1747 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1748 in one of these lines:
1753 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1754 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1755 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1756 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1759 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1760 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1762 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1763 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1767 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1768 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1769 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1770 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1771 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1772 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1773 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1774 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1775 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1776 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1777 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1778 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1780 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1781 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1782 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1783 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1784 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1785 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1787 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1788 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1789 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1790 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1791 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1792 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1795 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1796 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1797 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1798 facilities, you need to set
1800 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1802 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1803 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1806 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1807 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1808 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1809 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1810 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1811 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1812 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1814 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1815 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1816 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1817 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1818 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1823 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1824 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1826 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1827 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1828 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1829 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1830 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1831 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1832 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1834 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1835 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1836 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1837 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1838 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1842 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1846 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1847 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1848 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1849 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1850 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1851 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1852 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1853 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1854 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1855 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1858 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1859 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1862 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1865 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1867 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1868 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1871 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1872 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1874 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1875 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1879 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1881 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1882 library and include files. For example:
1886 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1887 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1889 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1890 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1891 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1896 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1897 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1898 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1899 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1900 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1901 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1902 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1903 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1904 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1905 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1906 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1909 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1910 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1911 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1913 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control files is
1914 &"exim"&. For example, the line
1916 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1918 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1919 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1920 All other connections are denied. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1925 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1926 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1927 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1928 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1929 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1930 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1933 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1934 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1935 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1936 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1937 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1938 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1939 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1940 support has not been tested for some time.
1944 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1945 .cindex "build directory"
1946 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1947 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1948 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1949 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1950 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1951 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1952 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1954 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1955 building process fails if it is set.
1957 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1958 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1959 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1960 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1961 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1962 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1963 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1964 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1966 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1967 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1968 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1972 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
1973 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
1974 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
1975 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
1976 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
1977 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
1978 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
1982 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
1983 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
1984 given in addition to the short output.
1988 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
1989 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
1990 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1991 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1992 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
1993 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1994 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
1997 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
1998 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2000 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2001 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2002 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2003 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2005 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2006 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2007 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2008 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2009 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2010 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2011 and are often not needed.
2013 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2014 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2015 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2016 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2017 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2018 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2019 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2020 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2021 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2024 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2025 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2026 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2027 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2031 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2032 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2033 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2034 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2035 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2036 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2037 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2038 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2039 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2040 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2041 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2042 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2043 containing the lines
2048 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2049 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2051 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2052 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2053 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2056 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2057 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2058 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2059 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2060 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2061 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2062 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2063 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2064 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2065 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2071 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2072 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2073 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2074 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2075 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2076 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2077 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2078 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2081 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2082 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2083 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2087 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2088 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2090 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2091 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2092 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2093 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2094 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2095 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2098 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2099 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2101 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2102 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2105 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2106 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2108 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2109 definition of all three of these variables into your
2110 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2113 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2114 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2115 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2116 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2118 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2119 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2120 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2121 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2122 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2125 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2126 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2127 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2128 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2129 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2132 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2134 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2135 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2136 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2137 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2138 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2139 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2143 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2144 .cindex "building Eximon"
2145 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2146 where the files that are involved are
2148 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2149 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2150 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2151 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2152 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2153 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2155 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2156 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2157 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2158 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2159 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2160 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2161 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2165 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2166 .cindex "installing Exim"
2167 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2168 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2169 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2170 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2171 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2172 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2173 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2174 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2175 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2176 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2177 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2178 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2180 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2181 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2182 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2183 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2184 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2185 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2186 alternative files, no default is installed.
2188 .cindex "system aliases file"
2189 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2190 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2191 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2192 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2193 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2194 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2195 and outputs a comment to the user.
2197 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2198 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2199 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2200 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2201 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2203 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2204 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2205 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2206 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2207 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2210 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2211 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2214 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2216 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2217 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2218 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2219 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2220 but this usage is deprecated.
2222 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2223 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2224 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2225 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2226 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2227 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2229 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2230 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2231 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2232 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2233 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2234 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2235 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2237 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2238 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2239 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2242 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2244 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2245 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2246 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2247 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2250 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2252 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2253 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2256 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2257 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2259 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2263 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2265 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2267 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2268 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2269 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2271 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2276 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2277 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2278 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2279 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2280 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2283 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2284 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2285 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2289 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2290 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2291 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2292 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2293 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2299 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2300 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2301 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2302 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2303 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2307 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2308 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2309 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2310 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2311 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2314 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2316 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2318 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2320 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2321 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2322 user agent. For example:
2324 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2325 From: user@your.domain.example
2326 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2327 Subject: Testing Exim
2329 This is a test message.
2332 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2333 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2334 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2336 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2337 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2338 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2339 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2340 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2341 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2343 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2345 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2346 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2347 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2348 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2349 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2351 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2352 .cindex "lock files"
2353 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2354 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2355 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2356 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2357 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2358 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2359 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2360 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2361 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2362 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2363 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2364 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2366 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2367 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2368 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2369 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2370 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2373 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2374 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2375 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2376 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2380 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2381 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2382 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2383 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2384 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2385 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2386 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2387 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2388 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2389 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2390 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2391 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2392 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2394 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2395 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2396 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2397 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2398 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2399 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2402 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2403 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2404 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2405 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2407 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2408 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2409 favourite user agent.
2411 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2412 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2413 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2414 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2415 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2416 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2420 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2421 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2422 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2423 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2424 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2425 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2426 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2427 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2433 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2434 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2435 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2437 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2439 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2440 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2441 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2442 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2443 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2445 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2447 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2449 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2450 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2451 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2456 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2459 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2460 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2461 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2462 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2463 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2464 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2465 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2466 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2467 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2470 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2472 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2473 were present before any other options.
2474 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2476 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2477 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2478 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2481 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2482 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2483 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2487 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2488 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2489 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2492 .cindex "queue runner"
2493 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2494 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2495 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2497 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2498 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2499 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2500 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2501 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2502 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2503 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2504 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2507 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2508 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2509 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2510 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2511 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2512 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2515 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2516 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2517 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2518 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2519 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2520 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2522 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2523 .cindex "envelope sender"
2524 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2525 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2526 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2527 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2528 users to set envelope senders.
2530 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2531 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2532 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2533 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2534 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2536 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2537 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2538 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2539 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2540 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2541 that are available to trusted users.
2543 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2544 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2545 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2546 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2547 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2549 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2550 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2551 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2552 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2554 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2555 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2556 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2557 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2559 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2560 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2565 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2566 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2567 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2573 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2574 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2575 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2576 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2577 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2578 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2579 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2580 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2582 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2583 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2584 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2585 . creates a man page for the options.
2586 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2589 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2596 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2597 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2598 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2599 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2602 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2603 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2604 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2607 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2609 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2610 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2611 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2612 clean; it ignores this option.
2617 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2618 .cindex "queue runner"
2619 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2620 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2621 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2623 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2624 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2625 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2626 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2628 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2629 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2630 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2631 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2633 When a listening daemon
2634 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2635 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2636 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2637 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2638 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2639 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2642 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2643 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2644 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2648 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2649 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2650 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2651 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2652 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2653 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2654 because these are reread each time they are used.
2658 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2659 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2663 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2664 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2665 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2666 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2667 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2668 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2670 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2671 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2672 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2673 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2674 test data. A line history is supported.
2676 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2677 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2678 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2679 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2680 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2681 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2682 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2684 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2685 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2686 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2687 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2689 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2691 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2692 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2693 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2694 of a file. For example:
2696 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2698 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2699 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2700 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2701 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2702 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2703 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2704 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2707 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2709 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2710 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2711 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2712 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2713 system filters are recognized.
2715 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2717 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2718 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2719 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2720 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2721 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2722 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2723 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2724 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2727 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2728 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2729 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2731 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2733 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2734 variables that are used by the user filter.
2736 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2741 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2742 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2743 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2746 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2747 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2748 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2749 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2751 When testing a filter file,
2752 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2753 .cindex "envelope sender"
2754 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2755 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2756 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2757 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2758 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2761 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2763 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2764 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2765 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2768 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2770 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2771 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2772 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2773 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2774 actually being delivered.
2776 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2778 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2779 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2782 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2784 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2785 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2788 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2790 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2791 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2792 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2793 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2794 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2795 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2796 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2797 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2798 after a full stop. For example:
2800 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2801 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2803 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2804 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2805 conversion to the canonical form is
2806 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2808 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2809 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2810 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2811 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2812 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2816 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2817 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2818 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2821 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2822 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2823 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2825 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2826 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2827 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2828 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2829 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2830 session were authenticated.
2832 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2833 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2834 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2836 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2837 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2838 specialized SMTP test program such as
2839 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2841 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2843 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2844 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2845 updating the callout cache database.
2849 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2850 .cindex "building alias file"
2851 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2852 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2853 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2854 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2855 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2858 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2859 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2860 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2861 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2862 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2863 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2868 .cindex "local message reception"
2869 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2870 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2871 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2872 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2873 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2874 if no other conflicting option is present.
2876 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2877 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2878 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2879 suppressing this for special cases.
2881 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2882 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2884 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2885 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2886 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2889 .cindex "message" "format"
2890 .cindex "format" "message"
2891 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2892 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2893 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2894 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2895 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2897 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2898 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2900 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2901 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2902 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2903 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2904 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2906 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2907 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2908 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2909 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2910 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2914 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2915 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2916 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2917 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2918 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2919 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2920 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2922 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2923 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2924 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2925 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2926 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2928 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2929 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2930 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2931 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2936 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2937 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2938 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2939 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2940 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2941 arguments, for example:
2943 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2945 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2946 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2947 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2948 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2949 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2950 users, the output is as in this example:
2952 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2954 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2955 configuration file is output.
2956 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2957 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2959 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2960 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2961 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2962 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
2963 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
2964 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
2965 written directly into the spool directory.
2967 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
2969 exim -bP +local_domains
2971 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2972 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2974 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
2975 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
2976 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
2977 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
2978 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2979 that driver are output. For example:
2981 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2983 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2984 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2985 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
2986 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2987 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
2990 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
2991 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
2992 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
2993 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
2994 The output format is one item per line.
2998 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
2999 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3000 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3001 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3002 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3003 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3004 to allow any user to see the queue.
3006 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3008 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3009 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3012 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3013 .cindex "size" "of message"
3014 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3015 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3016 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3017 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3018 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3019 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3020 before the sender address.
3022 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3023 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3024 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3026 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3027 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3028 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3029 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3030 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3036 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3037 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3038 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3044 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3045 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3046 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3047 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3052 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3053 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3054 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3055 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3059 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3063 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3068 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3069 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3070 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3071 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3076 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3077 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3078 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3079 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3080 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3082 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3083 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3085 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3086 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3087 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3088 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3089 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3090 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3091 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3092 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3093 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3095 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3096 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3101 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3102 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3103 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3104 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3105 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3106 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3107 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3111 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3112 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3113 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3114 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3115 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3116 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3117 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3118 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3119 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3121 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3122 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3123 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3125 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3126 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3127 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3128 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3130 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3131 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3132 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3134 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3135 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3136 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3137 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3138 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3140 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3141 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3145 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3146 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3147 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3148 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3149 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3150 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3151 messages to the MTA.
3154 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3155 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3156 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3157 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3158 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3159 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3160 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3164 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3165 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3166 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3167 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3168 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3169 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3170 the listening daemon.
3172 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3173 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3174 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3175 .cindex "malware scan test"
3176 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3177 using the malware scanning framework. The option of av_scanner influences
3178 this option, so if av_scanner's value is dependent upon an expansion then
3179 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. Exim will
3180 have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so using fully
3181 qualified pathnames is advisable. This option requires admin privileges.
3185 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3186 .cindex "address" "testing"
3187 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3188 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3189 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3190 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3191 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3193 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3194 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3196 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3197 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3200 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3201 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3202 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3203 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3204 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3207 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3208 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3209 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3210 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3212 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3213 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3214 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3215 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3218 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3219 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3221 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3222 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3223 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3224 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3225 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3226 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3231 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3232 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3233 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3234 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3235 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3236 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3238 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3239 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3240 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3241 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3242 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3243 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3244 dynamic testing facilities.
3248 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3249 .cindex "address" "verification"
3250 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3251 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3252 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3253 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3254 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3255 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3257 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3258 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3259 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3261 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3262 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3264 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3265 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3268 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3269 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3270 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3271 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3272 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3274 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3275 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3276 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3277 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3278 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3279 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3282 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3283 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3284 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3287 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3288 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3289 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3290 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3292 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3293 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3294 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3295 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3299 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3300 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3303 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3305 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3306 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3307 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3308 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3309 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3310 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3311 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3312 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3313 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3315 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3316 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3317 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3318 the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
3319 &_Local/Makefile_&, root privilege is retained for &%-C%& only if the caller of
3322 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3323 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3324 However, if you are using a &"packaged"& version of Exim (source or binary),
3325 the packagers might have enabled it.
3327 Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
3328 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
3329 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
3330 as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the delivery,
3331 the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception
3332 and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue,
3333 using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3335 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3336 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3337 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3338 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3339 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3340 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3341 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3343 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3344 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3345 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3348 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3349 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3350 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3351 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3352 specified by this option.
3354 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3356 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3357 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3358 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3359 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3360 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3361 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3363 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3364 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3365 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3371 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3372 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3375 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3377 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3379 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3381 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3382 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3383 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3384 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3385 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3386 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3387 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3390 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3391 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3392 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3393 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3394 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3395 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3396 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3399 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3400 &`auth `& authenticators
3401 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3402 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3403 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3404 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3405 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3406 &`filter `& filter handling
3407 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3408 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3409 &`ident `& ident lookup
3410 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3411 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3412 &`load `& system load checks
3413 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3414 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3415 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3416 &`memory `& memory handling
3417 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3418 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3419 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3420 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3421 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3422 &`retry `& retry handling
3423 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3424 &`route `& address routing
3425 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3427 &`transport `& transports
3428 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3429 &`verify `& address verification logic
3430 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3432 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3433 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3434 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3435 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3436 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3437 turn everything off.
3439 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3440 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3441 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3442 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3443 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3446 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3447 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3448 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3449 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3450 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3453 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3454 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3457 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3458 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3460 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3462 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3463 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3464 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3465 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3468 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3469 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3470 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3471 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3475 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3476 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3477 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3478 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3479 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3480 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3481 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3482 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3485 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3486 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3487 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3488 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3489 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3491 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3493 .cindex "sender" "name"
3494 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3495 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3496 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3497 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3498 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3499 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3501 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3503 .cindex "sender" "address"
3504 .cindex "address" "sender"
3505 .cindex "trusted users"
3506 .cindex "envelope sender"
3507 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3508 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3509 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3510 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3513 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3514 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3515 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3516 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3519 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3520 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3521 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3522 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3523 examples of shell commands:
3525 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3526 exim -f "" user@domain
3528 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3529 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3532 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3533 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3534 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3535 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3538 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3539 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3540 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3541 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3542 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3543 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3547 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3548 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3550 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3552 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3553 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3554 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3559 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3560 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3561 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3562 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3563 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3564 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3566 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3568 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3569 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3570 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3571 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3572 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3573 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3574 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3577 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3578 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3579 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3580 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3581 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3582 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3584 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3585 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3586 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3587 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3589 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3591 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3592 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3593 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3594 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3595 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3596 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3597 can be used only by an admin user.
3599 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3600 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3602 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3603 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3604 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3605 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3606 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3607 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3608 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3609 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3613 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3614 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3615 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3619 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3620 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3621 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3623 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3625 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3626 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3627 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3628 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3629 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3630 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3634 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3635 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3636 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3641 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3642 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3643 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3645 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3647 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3648 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3649 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3650 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3651 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3652 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3653 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3654 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3655 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3656 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3657 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3658 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3659 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3661 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3663 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3664 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3665 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3666 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3667 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3668 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3669 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3670 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3672 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3674 .cindex "freezing messages"
3675 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3676 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3677 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3678 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3679 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3680 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3683 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3685 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3686 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3687 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3688 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3689 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3690 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3691 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3692 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3695 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3697 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3698 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3699 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3700 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3701 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3703 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3705 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3706 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3707 .cindex "removing recipients"
3708 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3709 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3710 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3711 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3712 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3713 can be used only by an admin user.
3715 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3717 .cindex "removing messages"
3718 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3719 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3720 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3721 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3722 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3723 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3724 placed on the queue.
3726 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3728 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3729 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3730 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3731 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3732 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3733 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3734 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3735 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3736 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3738 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3740 .cindex "thawing messages"
3741 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3742 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3743 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3744 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3745 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3746 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3749 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3751 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3752 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3753 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3754 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3756 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3758 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3759 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3760 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3761 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3762 only by an admin user.
3764 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3766 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3767 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3768 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3769 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3770 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3772 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3774 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3775 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3776 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3777 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3781 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3782 treats it that way too.
3786 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3787 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3788 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3789 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3790 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3791 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3792 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3795 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3796 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3797 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3798 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3799 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3800 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3801 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3806 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3807 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3810 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3812 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3815 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3817 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3818 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3819 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3822 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3824 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3825 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3826 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3827 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3828 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3829 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3833 .cindex "background delivery"
3834 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3835 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3836 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3837 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3838 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3839 processes to finish.
3841 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3842 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3843 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3844 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3846 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3847 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3848 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3849 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3853 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3854 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3855 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3856 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3857 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3858 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3860 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3861 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3864 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3865 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3867 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3868 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3869 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3870 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3875 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3880 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3881 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3882 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3883 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3884 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3885 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3886 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3887 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3888 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3889 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3894 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3895 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3896 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3897 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3898 configuration file is in effect.
3900 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3901 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3902 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3903 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3904 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3905 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3906 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3907 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3908 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3913 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3914 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3915 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3918 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3920 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3921 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3922 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3923 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3927 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3928 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3929 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3930 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3931 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3935 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3936 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3937 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3938 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3939 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3943 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3944 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3949 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3950 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3955 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3956 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
3957 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
3958 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
3959 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
3960 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
3963 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
3964 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
3966 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
3968 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
3969 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
3970 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3971 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3972 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
3973 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3975 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
3976 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3978 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3980 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
3981 followed by a colon and the port number:
3983 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3985 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
3986 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
3987 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
3988 whichever one is last.
3990 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
3992 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
3993 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
3994 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
3995 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3996 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
3997 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
3999 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4001 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4002 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4003 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4004 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4005 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4006 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4008 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4010 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4011 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4012 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4013 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4014 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4015 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4016 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4017 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4019 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4021 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4022 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4023 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4024 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4025 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4027 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4029 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4030 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4031 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4032 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4033 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4034 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4035 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4036 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4037 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4040 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4042 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4043 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4044 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4045 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4046 uses the name it is given.
4048 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4050 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4051 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4052 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4053 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4054 used, when there is no default.
4058 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4059 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4060 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4061 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4065 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4066 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4067 whatever that means.
4069 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4071 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4072 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4073 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4074 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4075 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4076 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4077 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4079 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4081 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4082 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4083 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4084 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4085 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4087 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4089 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4090 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4091 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4092 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4093 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4094 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4098 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4100 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4102 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4103 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4104 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4105 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4106 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4107 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4108 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4109 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4113 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4114 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4115 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4116 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4121 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4122 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4123 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4124 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4127 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4129 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4131 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4133 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4134 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4135 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4136 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4137 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4141 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4142 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4143 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4144 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4145 and &%-S%& options).
4147 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4148 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4149 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4150 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4151 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4152 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4155 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4156 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4157 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4158 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4159 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4162 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4163 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4164 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4165 this to be repeated periodically.
4167 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4168 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4169 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4170 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4172 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4173 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4174 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4176 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4177 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4178 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4179 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4183 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4184 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4185 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4186 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4187 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4188 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4191 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4192 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4193 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4194 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4195 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4196 delivered down a single SMTP
4197 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4198 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4199 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4200 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4201 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4204 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4206 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4207 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4208 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4209 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4210 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4212 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4214 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4215 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4216 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4217 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4218 their retry times are tried.
4220 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4222 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4223 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4226 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4228 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4229 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4230 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4233 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4234 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4235 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4236 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4237 starting message id. For example:
4239 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4241 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4242 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4243 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4245 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4247 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4248 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4249 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4250 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4251 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4252 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4254 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4255 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4256 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4257 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4258 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4259 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4260 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4261 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4262 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4264 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4266 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4267 process every 30 minutes.
4269 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4270 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4272 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4274 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4277 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4279 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4281 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4283 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4284 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4285 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4286 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4287 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4288 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4289 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4291 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4292 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4293 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4294 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4295 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4296 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4298 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4299 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4301 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4303 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4304 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4305 applied to each queue run.
4307 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4308 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4309 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4310 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4311 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4312 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4313 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4314 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4315 address will be skipped.
4317 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4318 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4319 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4322 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4323 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4324 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4325 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4326 an arbitrary command instead.
4330 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4332 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4334 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4335 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4336 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4337 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4338 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4339 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4341 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4343 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4344 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4345 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4349 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4350 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4351 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4352 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4353 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4354 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4355 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4356 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4357 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4359 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4360 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4361 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4362 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4363 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4364 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4365 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4366 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4367 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4368 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4369 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4371 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4372 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4373 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4374 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4375 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4376 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4378 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4379 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4380 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4381 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4382 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4383 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4384 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4385 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4386 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4390 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4391 compatibility with Sendmail.
4393 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4394 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4395 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4396 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4397 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4398 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4399 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4400 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4405 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4406 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4407 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4408 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4409 set. Exim ignores this option.
4413 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4414 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4415 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4416 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4417 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4418 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4423 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4424 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4425 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4434 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4435 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4436 . creates a man page for the options.
4437 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4440 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4447 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4448 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4451 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4452 "The runtime configuration file"
4454 .cindex "run time configuration"
4455 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4456 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4457 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4458 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4459 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4460 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4461 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4462 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4465 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4466 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4467 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4468 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4469 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4470 actually alter the string.
4472 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4473 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4474 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4475 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4476 existing file in the list.
4479 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4480 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4481 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4482 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4483 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4484 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4485 specified at compile time by the EXIM_USER option, or by the user that is
4486 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4487 configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4488 group is the one specified at compile time by the EXIM_GROUP option or by the
4489 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4491 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4492 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4493 easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4494 of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
4495 configuration is not group writeable.
4497 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4498 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4499 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4500 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4501 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4502 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4507 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4508 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4509 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4510 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4511 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the
4512 Exim user (or unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value
4513 from CONFIGURE_FILE). &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4514 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4515 on a configuration file specified by &%-C%&.
4517 The privileged use of &%-C%& by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4518 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. However,
4519 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4520 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
4521 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
4522 as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4523 use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4524 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4525 &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
4527 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4528 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4529 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4530 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4531 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4533 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4534 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4535 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4536 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4537 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4538 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4540 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4541 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4542 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4543 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4544 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4545 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4546 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4548 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4549 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4550 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4554 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4555 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4556 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4557 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4558 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4559 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4560 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4564 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4567 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4568 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4569 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4571 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4572 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4573 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4575 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4576 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4577 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4579 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4580 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4581 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4582 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4585 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4586 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4587 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4589 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4590 want to use this feature, you must set
4592 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4594 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4595 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4598 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4599 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4600 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4601 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4603 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4604 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4605 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4606 and does not introduce a comment.
4608 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4609 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4610 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4611 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4612 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4614 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4615 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4616 change settings as required.
4618 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4619 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4620 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4621 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4622 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4627 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4628 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4629 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4630 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4631 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4632 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4635 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4636 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4638 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4639 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4640 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4643 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4644 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4645 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4646 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4648 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4649 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4652 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4655 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4656 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4661 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4662 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4663 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4664 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4665 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4666 definition, and must be of the form
4668 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4670 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4671 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4672 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4673 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4674 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4676 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4677 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4678 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4680 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4681 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4682 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4683 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4684 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4685 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4686 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4689 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4690 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4692 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4693 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4694 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4695 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4696 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4697 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4700 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4701 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4702 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4707 MAC == updated value
4709 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4710 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4711 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4712 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4716 MAC == MAC and something added
4718 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4719 from a number of other files.
4721 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4722 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4723 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4724 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4725 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4730 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4731 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4732 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4733 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4735 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4736 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4738 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4740 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4742 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4743 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4744 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4747 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4748 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4749 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4750 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4751 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4752 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4753 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4755 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4756 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4757 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4761 message_size_limit = 50M
4763 message_size_limit = 100M
4766 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4767 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4768 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4769 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4771 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4772 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4773 in this line"& will always be true.
4775 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4776 to clarify complicated nestings.
4780 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4781 .cindex "common option syntax"
4782 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4783 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4784 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4785 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4786 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4787 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4788 space) and then the value. For example:
4790 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4792 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4793 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4794 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4795 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4796 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4797 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4798 word &"hide"&. For example:
4800 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4802 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4804 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4806 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4807 all instances of the same driver.
4809 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4810 that are found in option settings.
4813 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4814 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4815 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4816 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4817 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4818 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4819 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4820 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4821 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4822 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4823 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4824 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4829 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4834 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4839 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4840 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4841 .cindex "format" "integer"
4842 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4843 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4844 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4845 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4848 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4849 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4850 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4851 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4852 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4856 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4857 .cindex "integer format"
4858 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4859 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4860 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4861 Such options are always output in octal.
4864 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4865 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4866 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4867 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4868 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4872 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4873 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4874 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4875 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4876 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4886 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4887 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4888 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4892 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4893 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4894 .cindex "format" "string"
4895 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4896 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4897 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4898 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4899 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4900 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4901 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4902 therefore equivalent:
4904 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4905 trusted_users = uucp:\
4906 # This comment line is ignored
4909 .cindex "string" "quoted"
4910 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4911 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4912 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4913 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4916 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4917 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
4918 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4920 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4921 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4925 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4926 character, that character replaces the pair.
4928 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4929 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4930 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4931 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4932 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4933 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4936 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
4937 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
4938 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
4939 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4940 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
4941 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
4942 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
4943 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
4944 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
4945 within a quoted configuration string.
4948 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
4949 .cindex "user name" "format of"
4950 .cindex "format" "user name"
4951 .cindex "groups" "name format"
4952 .cindex "format" "group name"
4953 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4954 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4955 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4956 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
4959 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
4960 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
4961 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
4962 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
4963 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4964 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
4965 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
4966 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
4967 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
4968 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
4969 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
4971 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4972 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
4973 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
4974 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
4975 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4976 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4979 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4981 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
4983 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
4984 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
4985 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
4986 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
4988 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
4989 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
4990 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
4991 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4992 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4993 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4994 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4995 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
4997 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4999 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5000 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5001 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5003 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5004 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5005 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5006 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5007 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5008 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5009 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5010 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5011 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5013 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5015 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5016 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5017 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5018 the value in quotes. For example:
5020 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5022 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5023 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5024 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5025 enclosing an empty list item.
5029 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5030 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5031 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5032 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5034 senders = user@domain :
5036 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5037 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5038 items, the second of which is empty:
5040 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5042 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5043 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5044 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5045 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5049 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5050 is at the end of the list.
5055 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5056 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5057 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5058 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5059 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5060 a sequence of lines like this:
5062 <&'instance name'&>:
5067 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5068 followed by three options settings:
5073 transport = local_delivery
5075 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5076 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5077 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5078 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5079 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5080 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5082 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5083 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5085 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5086 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5087 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5088 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5089 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5092 .cindex "generic options"
5093 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5094 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5095 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5096 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5097 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5098 .cindex "private options"
5099 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5100 they all have default values.
5102 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5103 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5104 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5106 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5107 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5108 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5109 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5110 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5111 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5112 configuration lines:
5117 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5118 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5119 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5120 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5126 command_timeout = 10s
5128 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5129 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5132 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5133 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5134 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5145 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5146 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5147 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5148 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5149 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5150 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5151 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5152 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5153 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5154 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5155 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5159 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5160 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5161 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5164 # primary_hostname =
5166 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5167 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5168 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5169 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5171 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5173 domainlist local_domains = @
5174 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5175 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5177 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5178 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5179 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5180 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5182 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5183 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5186 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5187 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5188 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5189 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5190 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5191 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5193 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5194 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5195 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5196 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5197 domain is permitted.
5199 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5200 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5201 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5202 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5203 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5204 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5206 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5207 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5208 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5210 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5212 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5213 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5215 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5216 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5217 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5218 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5219 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5220 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5221 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5222 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5223 contents of a message to be checked.
5225 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5227 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5228 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5230 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5231 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5232 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5233 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5235 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5237 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5238 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5239 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5241 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5242 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5243 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5244 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5245 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5246 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5247 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5249 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5251 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5252 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5254 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5255 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5256 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5257 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5258 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5259 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5260 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5261 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5262 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5263 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5264 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5265 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5266 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5267 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5268 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5269 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5271 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5274 # qualify_recipient =
5276 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5277 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5278 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5279 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5280 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5281 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5283 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5284 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5285 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5286 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5288 # allow_domain_literals
5290 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5291 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5292 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5293 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5294 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5295 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5297 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5301 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5302 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5303 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5304 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5305 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5306 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5307 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5308 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5310 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5311 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5316 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5317 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5318 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5319 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5320 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5321 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5324 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5325 1413 (hence their names):
5328 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5330 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5331 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5332 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5333 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5334 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5335 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5336 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5338 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5339 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5340 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5341 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5343 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5344 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5346 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5347 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5349 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5351 # percent_hack_domains =
5353 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5354 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5355 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5357 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5358 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5359 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5360 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5361 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5362 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5363 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5364 always bounce messages.
5366 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5367 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5369 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5370 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5371 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5372 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5373 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5377 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5378 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5379 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5380 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5381 It starts with the line
5385 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5386 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5387 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5389 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5390 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5391 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5392 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5393 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5394 result of the ACL processing.
5398 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5403 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5404 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5405 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5406 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5407 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5408 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5410 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5411 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5412 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5415 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5416 domains = +local_domains
5417 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5419 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5420 domains = !+local_domains
5421 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5423 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5424 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5425 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5426 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5427 in Internet mail addresses.
5429 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5430 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5431 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5432 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5433 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5434 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5435 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5436 policy of being as safe as possible.
5438 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5439 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5440 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5441 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5442 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5443 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5445 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5446 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5447 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5448 have to modify this rule.
5450 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5451 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5452 common convention of local parts constructed as
5453 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5454 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5455 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5456 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5457 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5458 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5460 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5461 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5462 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5463 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5464 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5465 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5466 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5468 accept local_parts = postmaster
5469 domains = +local_domains
5471 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5472 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5473 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5474 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5475 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5477 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5478 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5479 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5481 require verify = sender
5483 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5484 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5485 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5486 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5487 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5488 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5489 discusses the details of address verification.
5491 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5492 control = submission
5494 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5495 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5496 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5497 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5498 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5499 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5500 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5501 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5502 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5504 accept authenticated = *
5505 control = submission
5507 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5508 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5509 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5510 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5511 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5512 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5514 require message = relay not permitted
5515 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5517 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5518 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5520 require verify = recipient
5522 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5523 fails, the address is rejected.
5525 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5526 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5528 # dnslists = black.list.example
5530 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5531 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5532 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5533 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5535 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5536 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5537 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5540 # require verify = csa
5542 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5543 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5548 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5549 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5553 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5554 of this ACL are commented out:
5557 # message = This message contains a virus \
5560 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5561 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5562 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5563 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5565 # warn spam = nobody
5566 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5567 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5568 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5569 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5571 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5572 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5573 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5574 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5575 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5576 whatever the spam score.
5580 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5583 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5584 .cindex "default" "routers"
5585 .cindex "routers" "default"
5586 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5591 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5592 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5593 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5594 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5595 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5598 # driver = ipliteral
5599 # domains = !+local_domains
5600 # transport = remote_smtp
5602 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5603 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5604 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5605 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5606 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5610 domains = ! +local_domains
5611 transport = remote_smtp
5612 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5615 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5616 domains. This is specified by the line
5618 domains = ! +local_domains
5620 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5621 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5622 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5623 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5624 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5625 passed on to the following routers.
5627 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5628 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5629 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5630 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5631 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5633 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5634 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5635 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5636 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5637 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5638 the address fails and is bounced.
5640 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5641 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5642 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5643 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5644 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5645 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5646 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5653 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5655 file_transport = address_file
5656 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5658 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5659 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5660 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5661 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5662 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5665 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5666 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5667 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5668 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5673 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5674 # local_part_suffix_optional
5675 file = $home/.forward
5680 file_transport = address_file
5681 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5682 reply_transport = address_reply
5684 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5685 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5686 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5687 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5688 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5691 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5692 # local_part_suffix_optional
5694 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5695 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5696 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5697 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5698 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5699 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5700 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5702 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5703 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5704 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5705 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5707 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5708 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5709 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5710 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5711 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5712 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5713 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5715 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5716 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5717 There are two reasons for doing this:
5720 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5721 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5724 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5725 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5726 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5727 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5731 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5732 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5733 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5734 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5736 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5737 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5738 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5740 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5742 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5748 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5749 # local_part_suffix_optional
5750 transport = local_delivery
5752 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5753 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5754 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5755 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5756 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5759 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5760 .cindex "default" "transports"
5761 .cindex "transports" "default"
5762 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5763 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5764 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5768 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5773 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5774 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5778 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5785 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5786 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5787 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5788 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5789 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5790 show how this can be done.
5792 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5793 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5794 similarly-named options above.
5800 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5801 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5802 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5811 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5812 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5813 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5818 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5823 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5824 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5825 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5826 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5827 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5828 introduced by the line
5832 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5835 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5837 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5838 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5839 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5840 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5842 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5843 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5844 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5847 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5848 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5852 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5853 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5857 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5858 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5859 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5861 begin authenticators
5863 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5864 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5865 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5866 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5867 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5868 to support most MUA software.
5870 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5873 # driver = plaintext
5874 # server_set_id = $auth2
5875 # server_prompts = :
5876 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5877 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5879 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5882 # driver = plaintext
5883 # server_set_id = $auth1
5884 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5885 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5886 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5889 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5890 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5891 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5892 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5893 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5894 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5895 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5896 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5898 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5899 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5900 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5901 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5903 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
5904 usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
5907 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
5911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5914 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5916 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5918 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5919 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5920 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5921 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5922 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5923 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5925 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5926 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
5927 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
5928 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
5929 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
5932 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5933 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5934 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5935 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5937 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5939 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5940 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
5941 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5942 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5943 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5944 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
5947 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5948 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
5949 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
5950 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
5951 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
5952 match anywhere in the subject string.
5954 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5955 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5957 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5959 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
5962 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5964 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
5965 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
5969 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5970 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5972 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
5973 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
5974 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
5975 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
5976 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
5977 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
5980 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
5981 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
5982 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
5983 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
5984 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
5986 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
5987 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
5988 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
5989 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
5990 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5993 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
5994 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
5995 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
5996 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
5997 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
5998 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6000 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6001 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6002 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6003 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6004 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6006 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6007 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6009 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6010 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6011 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6012 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6013 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6015 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6016 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6018 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6019 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6021 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6022 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6023 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6028 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6029 matches the list item.
6031 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6032 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6034 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6036 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6037 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6038 causes a second lookup to occur.
6040 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6041 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6042 lookup is permitted.
6045 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6046 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6047 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6048 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6051 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6052 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6053 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6055 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6056 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6057 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6058 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6061 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6062 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6063 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6068 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6069 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6070 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6075 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6076 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6077 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6078 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6081 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6082 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6083 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6084 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6085 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6086 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6087 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6088 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6089 be found in several places:
6091 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6092 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6093 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6095 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6096 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6097 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6098 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6100 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6101 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6102 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6103 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6104 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6105 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6106 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6108 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6109 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6110 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6111 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6112 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6113 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6114 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6116 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6117 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6118 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6120 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6121 .cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6122 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6123 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6124 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6125 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6126 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6127 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6128 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6129 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6131 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6132 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6133 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6134 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6135 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6136 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6137 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6138 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6139 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6141 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6142 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6143 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6144 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6145 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6146 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6147 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6149 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6150 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6151 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6152 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6154 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6155 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6156 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6157 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6158 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6160 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6161 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6162 lookup types support only literal keys.
6164 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6165 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6166 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6168 .cindex "linear search"
6169 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6170 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6171 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6172 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6173 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6174 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6175 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6176 in the file is used.
6178 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6179 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6180 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6181 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6182 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6187 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6188 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6189 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6190 wildcarding of any kind.
6192 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6193 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6194 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6195 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6196 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6197 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6198 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6199 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6200 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6203 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6204 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6205 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6206 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6207 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6208 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6209 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6210 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6213 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6214 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6215 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6216 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6217 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6218 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6219 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6220 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6221 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6223 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6224 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6225 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6226 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6228 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6229 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6232 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6234 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6235 *fish data for anythingfish
6238 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6239 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6241 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6243 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6244 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6245 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6247 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6249 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6250 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6251 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6253 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6256 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6257 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6258 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6259 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6260 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6262 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6263 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6264 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6265 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6266 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6269 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6270 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6271 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6274 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6276 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6279 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6280 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6281 be followed by optional colons.
6283 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6284 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6285 lookup types support only literal keys.
6289 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6290 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6291 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6292 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6293 many of them are given in later sections.
6296 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6297 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6298 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6299 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6300 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6302 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6303 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6304 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6306 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6307 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6308 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6309 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6310 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6311 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6312 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6314 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6315 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6316 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6317 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6319 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6320 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6321 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6322 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6324 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6325 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6326 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6327 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6329 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6330 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6331 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6332 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6333 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6334 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6335 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6336 password value. For example:
6338 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6341 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6342 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6343 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6344 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6347 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6348 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6349 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6350 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6353 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6354 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6356 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6357 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6358 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6359 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6360 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6361 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6362 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6363 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6364 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6366 require condition = \
6367 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6369 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6370 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6371 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6372 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6377 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6378 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6379 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6380 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6381 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6382 options such as a list of local domains.
6384 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6385 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6386 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6387 or may give up altogether.
6391 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6392 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6393 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6394 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6395 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6396 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6397 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6398 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6400 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6401 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6402 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6404 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6405 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6406 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6408 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6409 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6410 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6411 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6412 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6413 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6414 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6415 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6416 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6417 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6419 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6421 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6422 looks up these keys, in this order:
6428 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6429 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6430 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6431 Exim move on to try the next key.
6435 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6436 .cindex "partial matching"
6437 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6438 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6439 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6440 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6441 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6442 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6443 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6444 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6445 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6446 a key in a DBM file is
6448 *.dates.fict.example
6450 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6451 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6452 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6455 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6456 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6457 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6459 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6460 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6461 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6462 partial matching keys
6463 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6464 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6465 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6467 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6468 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6469 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6470 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6471 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6472 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6475 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6476 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6477 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6478 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6479 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6480 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6482 2250.dates.fict.example
6483 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6484 *.dates.fict.example
6487 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6490 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6491 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6492 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6493 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6494 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6495 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6497 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6499 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6500 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6501 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6502 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6504 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6506 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6507 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6509 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6510 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6511 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6514 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6516 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6517 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6519 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6520 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6521 for &"*"& on its own.
6523 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6527 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6528 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6529 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6530 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6531 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6532 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6533 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6535 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6536 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6537 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6538 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6539 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6544 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6545 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6546 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6547 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6548 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6549 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6550 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6552 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6553 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6554 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6555 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6556 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6557 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6559 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6560 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6566 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6567 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6568 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6569 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6570 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6571 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6575 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6576 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6578 [name="$local_part"]
6580 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6581 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6582 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6583 of the following form is provided:
6585 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6587 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6589 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6591 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6592 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6593 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6598 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6599 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6600 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6601 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6602 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6603 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6604 an expansion string could contain:
6606 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6608 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6609 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6610 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6611 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6613 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6614 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6615 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6616 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6617 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6619 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6621 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6622 altered and nothing is added.
6624 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6625 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6626 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6627 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6628 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6630 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6631 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6632 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6633 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6634 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6635 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6637 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6639 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6640 white space is ignored.
6643 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6644 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6645 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6646 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6647 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6649 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6650 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6652 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6653 white space is ignored.
6656 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6657 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6658 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6659 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6660 the pseudo-type MXH:
6662 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6664 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6667 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6668 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6669 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6670 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6671 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6672 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6673 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6674 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6676 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6677 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6679 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6680 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6681 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6683 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6684 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6685 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6686 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6687 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6690 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6691 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6692 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6693 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6694 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6695 result of a successful lookup such as:
6697 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6699 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6700 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6701 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6704 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6705 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6706 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6707 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6708 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6710 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6711 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6712 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6714 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6715 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6716 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6717 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6719 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6720 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6721 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6723 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6724 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6725 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6726 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6727 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6728 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6729 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6730 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6731 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6732 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6734 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6735 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6737 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6738 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6743 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6744 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6745 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6746 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6747 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6748 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6749 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6750 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6751 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6752 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6753 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6754 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6756 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6757 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6758 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6759 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6760 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6762 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6763 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6765 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6766 the way they handle the results of a query:
6769 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6772 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6773 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6775 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6776 from all of them are returned.
6780 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6781 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6782 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6783 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6786 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6787 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6788 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6789 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6791 data = ${lookup ldap \
6792 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6793 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6795 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6796 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6797 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6798 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6801 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6802 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6803 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6804 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6805 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6806 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6808 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6809 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6817 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6818 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6822 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6824 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6828 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6830 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6832 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6834 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6835 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6836 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6840 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6841 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6842 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6844 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6848 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6850 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6852 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6854 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6855 authentication below.
6858 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6859 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6860 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6861 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6862 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6865 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6867 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6868 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6869 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6870 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6871 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6872 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6873 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6874 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6875 failures, and timeouts.
6877 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6878 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6879 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6880 doubled. For example
6882 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6884 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6885 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6886 the local host) is used.
6888 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6889 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6890 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6891 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6894 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6895 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6896 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6897 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6899 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6901 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6902 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6904 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6906 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6907 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6908 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6909 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6910 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6911 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6912 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6915 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6916 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6917 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6920 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6923 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6927 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6928 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
6932 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
6933 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
6934 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6935 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6936 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
6937 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6938 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6939 them. The following names are recognized:
6941 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
6942 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
6943 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6944 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
6945 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
6946 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
6947 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
6949 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
6950 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
6951 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
6952 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
6954 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6955 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6956 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6957 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6958 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6959 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6960 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6961 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
6962 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6964 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6965 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6968 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6969 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
6972 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6973 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6976 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
6977 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
6978 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
6979 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
6981 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6982 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6983 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6985 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
6986 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
6987 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
6988 quoting has two advantages:
6991 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
6992 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
6994 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
6997 For example, a setting such as
6999 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7001 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7003 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7004 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7005 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7006 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7010 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7011 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7016 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7017 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7018 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7019 as a sequence of values, for example
7021 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7023 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7024 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7025 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7026 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7027 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7030 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7031 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7032 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7034 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7035 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7036 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7037 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7038 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7039 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7040 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7042 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7043 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7044 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7046 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7049 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7052 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7053 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7055 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7056 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7058 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7059 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7060 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7061 results of LDAP lookups.
7066 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7067 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7068 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7069 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7070 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7071 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7072 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7073 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7075 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7077 might return the string
7079 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7080 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7082 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7084 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7090 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7091 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7092 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7096 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7097 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7098 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7099 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7100 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7101 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7102 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7103 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7104 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7105 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7106 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7107 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7110 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7113 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7114 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7116 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7121 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7123 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7124 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7125 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7129 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7130 with a newline between the data for each row.
7133 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7134 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7135 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7136 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7137 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7138 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7139 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7140 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7141 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7142 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7143 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7144 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7146 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7147 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7148 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7149 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7150 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7151 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7153 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7155 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7156 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7157 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7159 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7160 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7162 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7163 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7164 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7165 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7166 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7167 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7169 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7170 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7171 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7172 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7173 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7174 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7175 characters are not special.
7177 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7178 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7179 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7180 done by starting the query with
7182 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7184 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7186 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7187 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7188 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7191 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7193 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7194 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7195 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7197 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7198 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7199 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7202 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7206 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7208 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7210 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7211 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7212 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7214 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7218 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7219 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7220 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7221 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7222 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7224 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7225 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7227 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7228 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7230 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7233 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7234 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7236 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7237 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7238 is zero because no rows are affected.
7241 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7242 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7243 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7244 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7245 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7248 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7250 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7251 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7252 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7254 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7255 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7258 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7259 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7260 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7261 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7262 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7263 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7264 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7265 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7266 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7268 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7269 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7271 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7273 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7274 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7276 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7277 quote, which it doubles.
7279 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7280 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7281 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7282 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7283 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7284 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7290 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7291 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7293 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7294 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7295 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7296 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7297 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7298 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7299 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7300 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7301 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7303 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7304 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7305 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7306 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7310 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7311 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7312 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7313 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7314 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7315 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7316 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7317 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7320 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7321 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7322 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7324 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7325 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7326 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7327 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7328 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7330 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7331 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7333 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7334 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7335 senders based on the receiving domain.
7340 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7341 .cindex "list" "negation"
7342 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7343 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7344 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7345 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7346 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7347 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7349 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7350 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7351 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7352 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7353 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7355 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7357 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7358 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7359 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7361 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7363 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7364 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7365 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7367 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7368 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7373 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7374 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7375 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7376 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7377 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7378 file names are not allowed,
7379 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7380 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7384 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7385 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7387 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7388 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7389 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7391 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7395 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7396 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7397 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7398 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7400 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7401 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7403 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7405 and the file contains the lines
7410 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7411 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7415 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7416 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7417 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7418 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7419 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7420 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7421 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7422 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7424 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7425 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7426 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7427 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7432 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7433 .cindex "named lists"
7434 .cindex "list" "named"
7435 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7436 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7437 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7438 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7439 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7440 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7441 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7443 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7445 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7446 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7447 configured with the line
7449 domains = +local_domains
7451 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7452 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7456 domains = ! +local_domains
7457 transport = remote_smtp
7460 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7461 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7462 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7463 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7465 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7466 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7468 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7470 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7471 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7472 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7474 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7475 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7476 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7478 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7479 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7481 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7482 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7483 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7485 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7487 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7488 referenced lists if you can.
7490 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7491 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7492 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7494 domains = +local_domains
7496 on several of your routers
7497 or in several ACL statements,
7498 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7499 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7500 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7501 the same each time they are referenced.
7503 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7504 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7505 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7506 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7510 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7511 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7512 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7513 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7514 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7517 ALIST = host1 : host2
7518 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7520 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7522 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7524 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7527 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7528 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7530 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7532 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7536 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7537 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7538 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7539 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7540 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7541 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7542 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7543 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7544 message. For example:
7546 domainlist special_domains = \
7547 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7549 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7550 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7551 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7552 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7553 same list each time.
7555 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7556 cache the result anyway. For example:
7558 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7560 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7561 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7565 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7566 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7567 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7568 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7569 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7572 .cindex "primary host name"
7573 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7574 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7575 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7576 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7577 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7578 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7579 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7580 differ only in their names.
7582 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7583 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7584 .cindex "domain literal"
7585 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7586 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7587 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7588 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7589 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7590 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7593 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7594 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7595 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7596 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7597 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7598 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7599 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7600 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7601 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7602 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7603 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7605 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7606 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7607 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7608 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7609 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7611 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7612 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7613 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7614 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7615 on a router). For example:
7617 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7619 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7620 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7622 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7623 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7624 contain negative items.
7626 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7627 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7628 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7630 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7631 an.other.domain : ...
7633 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7634 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7636 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7637 an.other.domain ? ...
7640 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7641 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7642 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7643 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7644 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7645 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7646 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7647 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7648 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7652 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7653 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7654 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7655 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7656 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7657 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7658 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7659 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7660 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7662 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7663 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7664 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7665 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7666 expression by expansion, of course).
7668 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7669 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7670 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7671 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7672 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7673 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7675 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7677 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7678 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7679 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7680 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7681 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7682 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7683 other statements in the same ACL.
7686 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7687 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7689 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7691 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7692 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7695 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7696 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7697 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7698 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7699 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7700 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7703 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7704 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7705 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7706 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7708 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7709 where domain = '$domain';
7711 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7712 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7713 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7714 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7715 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7717 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7718 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7719 between the pattern and the domain.
7722 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7724 domainlist funny_domains = \
7727 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7728 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7729 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7730 nis;domains.byname : \
7731 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7733 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7734 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7735 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7736 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7737 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7742 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7743 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7744 .cindex "list" "host list"
7745 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7746 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7747 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7748 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7749 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7750 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7751 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7754 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7755 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7756 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7757 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7758 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7759 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7762 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7763 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7764 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7768 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7769 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7770 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7771 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7772 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7773 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7774 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7777 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7778 inspecting its IP address:
7781 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7782 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7783 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7784 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7785 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7786 with the IP address of the subject host.
7788 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7789 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7790 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7791 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7792 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7795 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7796 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7797 domain name, as just described.
7800 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7801 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7802 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7803 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7804 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7805 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7806 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7807 that can never match a client host.
7810 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7811 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7812 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7813 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7815 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7819 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7820 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7821 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7822 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7823 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7824 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7825 significant end of the address.
7827 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7828 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7829 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7830 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7834 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7835 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7838 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7840 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7841 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7843 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7844 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7847 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7849 could make use of a file containing
7854 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7855 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7856 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7858 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7861 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7867 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7868 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7869 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7870 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7871 address, the pattern takes this form:
7873 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7877 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7879 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7880 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7881 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7882 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7883 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7884 returned by the lookup is not used.
7886 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
7887 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7888 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7889 patterns of this form:
7891 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7895 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7897 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7898 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7899 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7900 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7901 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7903 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7904 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7905 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7906 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7907 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7908 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7909 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7910 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7911 addresses are always used.
7913 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7914 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7915 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7918 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7919 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7920 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7921 case the IP address is used on its own.
7925 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7926 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
7927 .cindex "unknown host name"
7928 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
7929 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7930 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7931 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7932 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
7935 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7936 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7937 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7938 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7939 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7940 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7941 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7943 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7944 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7946 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7947 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
7948 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7949 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
7950 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
7951 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
7952 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
7953 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
7954 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
7956 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7957 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7959 .cindex "host" "alias for"
7960 .cindex "alias for host"
7961 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7962 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7965 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7966 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
7967 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
7968 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7969 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7972 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
7973 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
7974 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7975 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
7976 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
7977 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
7978 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
7983 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
7984 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
7985 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
7986 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
7987 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
7989 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
7991 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
7992 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
7993 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8000 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8001 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8002 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8003 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8004 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8005 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8007 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8008 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8010 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8011 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8012 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8013 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8014 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8015 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8018 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8019 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8021 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8023 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8024 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8027 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8028 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8031 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8034 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8035 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8036 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8039 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8040 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8044 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8046 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8047 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8048 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8049 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8050 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8051 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8052 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8053 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8054 host lists such as whitelists.
8058 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8059 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8060 .cindex "unknown host name"
8061 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8062 If a pattern is of the form
8064 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8068 dbm;/host/accept/list
8070 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8071 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8074 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8075 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8076 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8077 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8078 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8079 lookup, both using the same file.
8083 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8084 If a pattern is of the form
8086 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8088 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8089 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8090 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8092 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8093 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8095 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8096 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8097 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8100 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8101 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8102 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8104 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8105 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8106 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8107 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8108 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8109 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8113 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8115 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8116 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8117 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8120 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8122 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8123 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8124 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8125 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8126 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8127 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8129 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8130 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8132 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8133 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8135 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8136 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8142 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8143 .cindex "list" "address list"
8144 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8145 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8146 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8147 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8148 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8149 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8150 using this option setting:
8154 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8155 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8156 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8157 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8159 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8162 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8164 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8165 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8166 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8167 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8168 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8169 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8170 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8172 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8173 *@+hostile_domains:\
8174 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8175 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8177 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8178 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8179 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8180 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8181 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8183 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8184 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8185 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8186 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8187 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8189 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8192 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8193 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8197 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8198 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8199 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8200 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8201 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8202 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8203 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8205 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8206 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8208 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8209 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8212 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8213 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8214 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8217 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8218 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8219 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8221 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8222 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8223 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8224 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8226 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8227 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8229 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8230 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8231 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8232 default. For example, with this lookup:
8234 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8236 the file could contains lines like this:
8238 user1@domain1.example
8241 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8244 nimrod@jaeger.example
8248 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8249 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8251 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8253 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8254 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8256 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8257 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8258 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8262 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8263 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8268 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8269 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8270 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8271 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8272 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8273 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8274 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8275 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8276 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8278 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8279 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8280 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8281 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8282 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8285 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8287 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8289 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8291 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8293 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8294 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8295 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8296 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8297 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8298 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8300 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8303 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8306 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8307 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8308 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8309 might have entries like
8311 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8312 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8315 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8316 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8317 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8318 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8320 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8321 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8322 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8325 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8326 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8327 can only return a single list of local parts.
8330 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8331 in these two examples:
8334 senders = *@+my_list
8336 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8337 example it is a named domain list.
8342 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8343 .cindex "case of local parts"
8344 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8345 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8346 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8347 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8348 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8349 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8350 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8351 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8354 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8355 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8356 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8357 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8358 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8359 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8360 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8363 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8364 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8365 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8366 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8367 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8368 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8369 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8370 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8374 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8375 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8376 .cindex "local part" "list"
8377 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8378 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8379 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8380 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8381 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8382 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8383 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8384 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8386 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8387 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8388 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8389 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8390 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8391 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8392 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8394 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8399 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8400 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8402 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8403 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8404 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8405 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8407 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8408 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8409 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8410 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8411 escape character, as described in the following section.
8415 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8416 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8417 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8418 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8419 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8420 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8421 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8422 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8424 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8425 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8426 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8427 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8429 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8431 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8432 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8437 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8438 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8439 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8440 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8441 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8442 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8443 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8446 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8447 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8448 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8451 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8452 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8453 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8455 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8456 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8457 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8458 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8459 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8460 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8461 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8464 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8465 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8466 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8469 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8470 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8471 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8472 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8474 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8476 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8477 Exim message identifier. For example:
8479 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8481 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8482 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8485 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8486 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8487 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8488 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8489 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8490 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8491 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8492 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8493 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8494 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8495 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8496 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8502 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8503 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8504 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8505 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8506 white space is significant.
8509 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8510 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8511 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8516 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8517 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8518 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8519 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8520 given, the expansion fails.
8522 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8523 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8524 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8525 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8529 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8530 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8531 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8532 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8533 string easier to understand.
8535 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8536 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8537 expansion item below.
8539 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8540 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8542 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8543 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8547 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8548 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8549 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8551 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8552 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8553 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8554 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8555 must have the following type:
8557 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8559 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8560 function should return one of the following values:
8562 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8563 into the expanded string that is being built.
8565 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8566 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8568 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8569 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8571 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8573 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8574 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8575 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8577 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8578 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8579 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8580 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8581 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8582 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8583 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8586 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8589 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8590 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8591 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8592 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8593 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8594 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8595 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8596 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8597 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8599 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8600 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8601 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8604 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8605 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8607 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8608 appear, for example:
8610 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8612 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8613 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8616 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8617 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8618 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8619 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8620 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8621 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8622 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8623 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8624 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8625 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8626 <&'string3'&> as before.
8628 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8629 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8630 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8631 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8632 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8633 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8634 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8635 provided. For example:
8637 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8641 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8643 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8644 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8647 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8648 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8649 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8651 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8652 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8653 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8654 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8655 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8656 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8657 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8659 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8661 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8662 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8665 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8666 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8667 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8668 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8669 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8670 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8672 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8673 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8674 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8675 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8677 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8679 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8680 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8681 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8682 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8683 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8685 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8687 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8688 letters appear. For example:
8690 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8691 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8692 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8695 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8696 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8697 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8698 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8699 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8700 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8701 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8702 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8703 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8704 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8705 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8706 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8707 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8708 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8712 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8713 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8714 lines) may be present.
8716 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8717 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8720 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8721 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8722 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8725 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8726 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8727 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8728 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8729 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8730 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8731 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8732 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8735 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8736 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8737 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8738 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8739 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8740 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8743 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8744 command of the following form:
8746 headers charset "UTF-8"
8748 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8749 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8750 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8751 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8752 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8755 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8756 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8757 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8758 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8760 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8761 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8762 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8763 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8764 router or transport are not accessible.
8766 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8767 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8768 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8769 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8770 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8771 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8773 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8774 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8775 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8776 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8777 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8778 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8779 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8781 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8782 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8783 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8784 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8785 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8786 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8787 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8788 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8791 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8792 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8794 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8795 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8796 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8797 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8798 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8799 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8800 present. For example:
8802 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8804 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8807 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8809 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8810 an Exim configuration:
8812 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8814 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8817 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8818 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8819 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8821 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8822 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8823 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8824 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8825 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8826 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8829 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8830 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8831 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8832 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8833 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8834 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8836 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8838 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8839 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8840 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8841 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8842 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8844 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8845 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8846 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8848 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8852 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8855 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8856 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8857 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8858 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8859 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8860 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8861 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8864 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8866 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8867 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8868 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8871 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8872 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8873 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8874 described in the next item.
8876 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8877 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8878 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8879 .cindex "file" "lookups"
8880 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8881 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8882 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8883 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8884 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8886 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8887 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8888 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8889 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8890 out by the system administrator.
8893 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8894 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8895 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8896 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8897 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8898 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8899 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8900 original lookup fails.
8902 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8903 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8904 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8905 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8906 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8907 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8908 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8909 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8911 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8912 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8913 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8914 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8916 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8917 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8918 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8919 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8921 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8923 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8925 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8926 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8928 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8933 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8934 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
8936 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8937 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8938 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
8939 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
8940 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
8941 setting is not included in the output. For example:
8943 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
8945 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
8946 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
8947 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8949 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8950 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
8951 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
8952 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8953 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
8954 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
8955 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8957 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8959 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8960 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8961 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8962 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
8965 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8967 returns the string &"6/33"&.
8971 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
8972 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
8973 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
8974 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8975 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8976 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
8977 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
8978 name of the subroutine, is nine.
8980 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
8981 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
8982 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
8983 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
8984 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
8987 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
8988 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
8989 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
8991 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
8992 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
8995 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
8996 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
8997 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
8998 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
8999 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9000 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9001 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9002 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9004 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9005 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9006 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9007 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9008 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9009 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9010 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9011 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9012 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9013 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9015 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9016 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9017 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9018 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9020 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9021 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9022 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9023 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9024 is the expansion of the third argument.
9026 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9027 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9028 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9030 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9031 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9032 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9033 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9034 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9035 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9036 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9037 newlines are left in the string.
9038 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9039 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9040 the string expansion fails.
9042 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9043 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9047 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9048 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9049 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9050 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9051 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9052 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9053 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9056 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9057 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9059 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9060 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9061 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9062 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9063 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9066 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9068 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9069 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9070 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9071 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9072 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9073 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9075 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9077 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9078 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9079 turns them into spaces:
9081 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9083 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9084 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9085 addition, the following errors can occur:
9088 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9090 Failure to connect the socket;
9092 Failure to write the request string;
9094 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9097 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9098 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9099 errors occurs. For example:
9101 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9104 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9105 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9106 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9107 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9108 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9110 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9111 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9114 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9115 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9116 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9119 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9120 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9121 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9122 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9123 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9124 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9125 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9126 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9127 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9129 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9131 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9134 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9136 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9137 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9140 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9141 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9142 expansion item above.
9144 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9145 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9146 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9147 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9148 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9149 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9150 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9151 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9153 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9154 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9155 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9157 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9158 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9159 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9160 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9161 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9164 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9165 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9166 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9167 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9170 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9171 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9173 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9174 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9178 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9179 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9182 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9183 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9184 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9185 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9187 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9188 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9191 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9192 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9193 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9194 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9195 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9196 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9197 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9198 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9200 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9202 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9203 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9204 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9206 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9208 yields &"defabc"&, and
9210 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9212 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9213 the regular expression from string expansion.
9217 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9218 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9219 .cindex "substring extraction"
9220 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9221 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9222 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9223 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9224 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9226 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9228 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9229 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9232 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9233 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9234 length required. For example
9236 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9238 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9239 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9240 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9241 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9243 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9244 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9245 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9247 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9249 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9250 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9251 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9253 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9255 yields an empty string, but
9257 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9261 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9262 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9263 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9264 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9267 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9269 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9273 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9274 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9275 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9276 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9277 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9278 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9279 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9280 replacement list. For example
9282 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9284 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9285 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9286 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9292 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9293 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9294 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9295 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9296 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9297 following operations can be performed:
9300 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9301 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9302 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9303 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9304 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9305 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9308 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9309 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9310 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9311 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9312 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9313 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9314 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9315 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9316 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9318 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9319 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9320 character. For example:
9322 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9324 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9325 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9326 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9330 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9331 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9332 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9333 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9334 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9335 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9336 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9337 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9338 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9340 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9341 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9342 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9343 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9344 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9345 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9348 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9349 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9350 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9351 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9352 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9355 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9356 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9357 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9358 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9359 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9360 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9361 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9364 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9365 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9366 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9367 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9368 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9369 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9370 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9371 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9372 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9373 C programming language):
9375 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9376 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9377 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9378 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9381 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9383 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9384 space is permitted before or after operators.
9386 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9387 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9388 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9389 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9390 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9392 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9393 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9394 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9397 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9398 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9399 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9400 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9401 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9402 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9403 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9404 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9405 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9406 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9407 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9410 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9412 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9415 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9418 {$recipients_count} \
9419 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9423 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9424 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9427 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9428 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9429 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9432 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9434 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9435 and then re-expands what it has found.
9438 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9440 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9441 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9442 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9443 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9444 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9445 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9446 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9447 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9448 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9450 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9451 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9452 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9453 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9454 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9455 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9456 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9459 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9460 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9461 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9462 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9463 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9464 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9466 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9468 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9469 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9473 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9474 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9475 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9476 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9477 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9478 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9481 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9482 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9483 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9484 .cindex "lower casing"
9485 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9486 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9487 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9492 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9493 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9494 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9495 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9496 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9497 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9499 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9501 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9502 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9503 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9506 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9507 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9508 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9509 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9510 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9514 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9515 .cindex "masked IP address"
9516 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9517 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9518 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9519 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9520 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9521 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9522 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9523 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9524 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9526 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9528 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9529 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9530 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9531 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9533 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9537 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9539 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9542 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9544 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9545 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9546 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9547 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9550 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9551 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9552 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9553 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9554 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9555 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9557 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9559 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9562 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9563 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9564 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9565 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9566 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9567 is an empty string or
9568 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9569 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9570 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9571 respectively For example,
9579 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9580 variable or a message header.
9582 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9583 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9584 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9585 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9586 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9587 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9588 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9591 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9592 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9593 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9594 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9595 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9597 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9603 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9604 yields an unchanged string.
9607 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9608 .cindex "random number"
9609 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9610 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9611 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9612 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9613 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9614 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9618 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9619 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9620 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9621 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9622 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9623 for DNS. For example,
9625 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4} and ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9629 4.2.0.192 and 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9633 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9634 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9635 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9636 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9637 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9638 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9639 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9640 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9641 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9644 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9646 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9647 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9651 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9652 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9653 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9654 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9655 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9656 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9657 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9658 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9660 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9661 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9662 to use this operator as well.
9666 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9667 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9668 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9669 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9670 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9671 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9672 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9675 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9676 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9677 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9678 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9679 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9680 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9683 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9684 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9685 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9686 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9687 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9688 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9689 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9690 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9691 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9692 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9693 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9694 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9695 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9697 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9698 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9699 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9701 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9702 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9703 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9704 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9705 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9709 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9710 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9711 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9712 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9713 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9714 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9717 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9718 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9719 .cindex "substring extraction"
9720 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9721 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9722 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9723 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9725 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9727 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9728 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9730 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9731 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9732 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9733 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9736 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9737 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9738 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9739 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9740 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9741 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9744 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9745 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9746 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9747 .cindex "upper casing"
9748 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9749 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9750 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9758 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9759 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9760 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9761 while expanding strings:
9764 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9765 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9766 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9767 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9770 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9771 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9772 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9773 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9779 &`>= `& greater or equal
9781 &`<= `& less or equal
9785 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9787 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9788 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9789 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9790 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9791 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9794 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9795 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9796 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9797 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9798 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9799 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9800 false if zero. Leading whitespace is ignored.
9801 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9803 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9804 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9807 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9810 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9811 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9812 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9813 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9814 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9815 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9816 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9817 included in the binary.
9819 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9820 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9821 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9822 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9823 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9824 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9825 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9826 string in LDAP form is:
9828 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9830 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9831 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9833 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9835 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9840 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9841 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9842 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9843 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9844 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9845 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9849 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9850 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9851 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9852 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9853 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9854 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9857 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9858 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9859 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9860 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9861 whatever its length.
9864 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9865 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9866 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9867 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9869 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9870 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9871 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9872 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9873 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9874 support &[crypt16()]&.
9876 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9877 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9878 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9879 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9880 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9882 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9883 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9884 Exim is seen as very low priority.
9886 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9887 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9888 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9889 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9890 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9892 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9893 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9894 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9895 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9896 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9897 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9899 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9901 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9902 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9904 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9905 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9906 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9907 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9908 exists in the message. For example,
9910 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9912 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9913 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
9915 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9916 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9917 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9918 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9919 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
9920 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
9921 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9922 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
9923 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
9925 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
9926 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
9927 .cindex "file" "existence test"
9928 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
9929 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9930 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9931 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
9932 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9934 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
9935 .cindex "delivery" "first"
9936 .cindex "first delivery"
9937 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
9938 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
9939 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9940 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9943 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
9944 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
9945 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
9946 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
9947 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
9949 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
9950 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
9951 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
9952 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
9953 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
9955 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
9956 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
9957 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
9959 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
9960 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
9961 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
9963 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
9964 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
9965 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
9966 list separator is changed to a comma:
9968 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
9970 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
9971 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
9974 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9975 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9976 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9977 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9978 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
9979 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
9980 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9981 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
9982 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
9985 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9986 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9987 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9988 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9989 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
9990 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
9991 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9992 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
9993 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
9996 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9997 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9998 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9999 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10000 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10001 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10002 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10003 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10004 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10005 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10006 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10008 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10009 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10010 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10011 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10012 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10014 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10015 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10016 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10017 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10019 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10021 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10023 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10024 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10025 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10026 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10027 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10028 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10029 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10030 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10031 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10032 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10033 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10034 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10035 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10039 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10040 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10041 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10042 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10043 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10044 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10045 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10046 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10047 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10050 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10051 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10052 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10053 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10054 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10055 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10056 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10057 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10058 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10062 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10063 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10064 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10065 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10066 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10067 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10068 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10069 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10070 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10071 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10072 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10075 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10077 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10078 backslashes is also required.
10080 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10081 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10082 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10083 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10084 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10085 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10087 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10088 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10089 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10090 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10091 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10092 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10093 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10094 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10096 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10097 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10098 See &*match_local_part*&.
10100 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10101 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10102 See &*match_local_part*&.
10104 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10105 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10106 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10107 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10108 address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10109 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10111 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10113 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10116 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10118 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10120 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10121 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10122 in a single test such as
10123 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10124 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10125 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10126 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10128 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10130 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10132 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10134 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10135 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10136 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10137 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10138 masks. For example:
10140 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10142 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10143 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10144 address mask, for example:
10146 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10148 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10149 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10151 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10155 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10157 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10158 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10159 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10160 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10161 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10162 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10163 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10164 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10167 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10169 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10170 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10171 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10172 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10174 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10176 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10177 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10178 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10179 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10182 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10183 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10184 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10185 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10187 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10188 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10189 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10190 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10191 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10192 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10193 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10194 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10195 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10196 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10197 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10201 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10202 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10204 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10205 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10206 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10207 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10208 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10209 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10210 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10212 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10213 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10214 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10215 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10216 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10218 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10220 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10222 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10224 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10225 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10226 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10227 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10228 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10229 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10230 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10231 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10234 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10235 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10237 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10238 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10239 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10240 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10241 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10242 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10244 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10245 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10246 building Exim. For example:
10248 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10250 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10251 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10252 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10253 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10255 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10256 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10257 configuration, you might have this:
10259 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10261 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10263 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10265 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10266 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10267 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10268 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10269 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10270 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10273 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10275 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10276 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10277 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10278 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10279 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10282 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10283 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10284 this library, you need to set
10286 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10288 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10289 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10291 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10293 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10294 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10295 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10297 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10298 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10299 the authentication is successful. For example:
10301 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10305 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10306 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10307 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10309 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10310 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10311 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10312 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10313 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10314 by a process that is not running as root.
10316 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10317 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10318 building Exim. For example:
10320 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10322 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10323 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10324 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10326 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10327 two are mandatory. For example:
10329 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10331 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10332 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10333 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10338 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10339 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10340 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10341 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10342 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10343 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10344 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10348 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10349 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10350 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10351 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10352 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10355 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10357 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10358 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10359 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10361 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10362 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10363 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10364 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10365 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10366 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10367 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10368 parsed but not evaluated.
10370 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10375 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10376 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10377 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10378 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10379 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10382 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10383 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10384 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10385 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10386 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10387 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10388 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10389 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10390 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10391 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10392 matching condition.
10394 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10395 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10396 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10397 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10398 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10399 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10400 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10401 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10402 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10403 during subsequent delivery.
10405 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10406 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10407 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10408 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10409 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10410 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10411 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10412 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10415 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10416 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10417 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10418 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10419 be preserved by coding like this:
10421 warn !verify = sender
10422 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10424 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10425 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10428 .vitem &$address_data$&
10429 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10430 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10431 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10432 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10433 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10434 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10437 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10438 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10439 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10440 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10441 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10442 from the child's routing.
10444 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10445 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10446 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10449 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10450 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10451 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10453 .vitem &$address_file$&
10454 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10455 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10456 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10457 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10458 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10460 /home/r2d2/savemail
10462 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10463 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10464 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10465 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10466 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10467 to the relevant file.
10469 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10470 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10471 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10472 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10474 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10475 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10476 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10477 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10479 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10480 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10481 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10482 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10483 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10484 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10485 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10486 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10487 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10488 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10489 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10490 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10491 command line option.
10496 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10497 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10498 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10499 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10500 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10501 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10502 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10503 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10504 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10505 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10506 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10508 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10509 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10510 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10511 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10512 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10515 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10516 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10517 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10518 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10519 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10520 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10521 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10522 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10523 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10524 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10525 an undefined mechanism.
10527 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10528 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10529 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10530 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10531 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10532 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10534 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10535 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10536 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10537 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10538 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10539 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10540 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10542 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10543 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10544 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10545 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10546 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10548 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10549 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10550 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10551 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10552 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10554 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10555 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10556 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10557 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10558 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10559 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10560 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10562 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10563 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10564 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10565 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10566 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10567 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10568 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10570 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10571 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10572 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10574 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10575 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10576 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10577 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10578 compilations of the same version of the program.
10580 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10581 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10582 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10583 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10584 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10586 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10587 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10588 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10589 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10590 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10592 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10593 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10594 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10596 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10597 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10598 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10599 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10600 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10601 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10602 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10603 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10604 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10607 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10608 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10609 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10610 case for &$domain$&.
10612 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10613 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10614 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10615 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10617 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10618 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10619 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10620 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10621 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10622 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10624 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10625 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10626 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10628 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10631 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10632 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10633 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10634 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10635 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10636 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10637 the &(smtp)& transport.
10640 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10641 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10642 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10643 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10646 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10647 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10648 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10649 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10650 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10651 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10654 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10655 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10656 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10657 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10661 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10662 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10663 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10664 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10665 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10666 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10667 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10670 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10671 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10672 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10675 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10676 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10677 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10679 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10680 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10681 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10683 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10684 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10685 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10687 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10688 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10689 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10690 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10691 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10693 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10694 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10695 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10696 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10697 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10701 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10702 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10703 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10704 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10705 by a setting on the transport itself.
10707 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10708 of the environment variable HOME.
10712 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10713 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10714 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10715 to local and remote transports.
10717 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10718 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10719 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10720 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10721 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10722 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10723 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10726 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10727 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10728 client is connected.
10731 .vitem &$host_address$&
10732 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10733 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10734 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10735 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10737 .vitem &$host_data$&
10738 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10739 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10740 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10741 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10743 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10744 message = $host_data
10746 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10747 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10748 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10749 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10750 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10751 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10752 variables is set to &"1"&.
10755 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10756 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10759 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10760 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10761 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10764 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10765 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10766 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10767 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10768 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10769 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10770 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10771 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10772 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10773 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10775 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10776 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10777 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10781 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10782 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10783 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10784 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10785 a unique name for the file.
10787 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10788 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10789 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10791 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10792 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10793 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10797 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10798 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
10799 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10803 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10804 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10805 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10808 .vitem &$load_average$&
10809 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10810 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10811 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10812 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10814 .vitem &$local_part$&
10815 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10816 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10817 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10818 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10819 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10821 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10822 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10823 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10824 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10827 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10828 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10829 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10830 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10831 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10832 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10834 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10835 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10836 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10839 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10840 local part of the recipient address.
10842 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10843 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10844 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10846 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10849 "abc:xyz"@test.example
10850 abc\:xyz@test.example
10852 the value of &$local_part$& is
10856 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10857 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10860 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10862 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10863 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10864 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10866 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
10867 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10868 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10869 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10870 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10871 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10872 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10874 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10875 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10876 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10877 variable expands to nothing.
10879 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10880 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10881 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10882 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10883 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10885 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10886 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10887 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10888 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10889 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10891 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10892 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10893 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10894 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10896 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10897 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10898 See &$local_user_uid$&.
10900 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10901 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10902 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10903 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10904 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
10905 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
10906 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
10907 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
10909 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
10910 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
10911 This contains the expanded value of the
10912 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
10915 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
10916 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
10917 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10918 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
10919 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10920 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
10922 .vitem &$log_space$&
10923 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
10924 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
10925 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
10926 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
10927 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
10928 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
10931 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
10932 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
10933 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
10934 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
10935 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
10936 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
10937 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
10940 .vitem &$malware_name$&
10941 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
10942 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10943 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
10944 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
10946 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
10947 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
10948 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
10949 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
10950 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
10951 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
10954 .vitem &$message_age$&
10955 .cindex "message" "age of"
10956 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
10957 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
10958 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
10961 .vitem &$message_body$&
10962 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10963 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10964 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10965 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
10966 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
10967 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
10968 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
10969 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
10970 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
10972 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
10973 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
10974 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
10975 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
10976 zeros are always converted into spaces.
10978 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
10979 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10980 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10981 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
10982 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
10983 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
10986 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
10987 .cindex "body of message" "size"
10988 .cindex "message body" "size"
10989 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
10990 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
10991 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
10992 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
10993 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
10995 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
10996 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
10997 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10998 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
10999 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11000 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11001 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11002 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11004 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11005 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11006 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11007 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11008 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11009 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11011 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11012 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11013 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11014 contents of header lines is done.
11016 .vitem &$message_id$&
11017 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11019 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11020 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11021 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11022 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11023 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11024 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11025 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11026 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11027 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11028 from the body is not counted. Here is an example of the use of this variable in
11031 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11033 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11035 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11036 message has not yet been received.
11038 .vitem &$message_size$&
11039 .cindex "size" "of message"
11040 .cindex "message" "size"
11041 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11042 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11043 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11044 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11045 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11046 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11047 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11048 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11049 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11051 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11052 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11053 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11054 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11056 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11057 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11058 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11059 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11061 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11062 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11063 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11065 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11066 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11067 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11068 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11069 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11070 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11071 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11072 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11073 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11074 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11076 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11077 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11078 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11080 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11081 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11082 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11083 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11084 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11085 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11086 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11087 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11088 the original address.
11090 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11091 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11092 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11093 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11094 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11096 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11097 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11098 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11100 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11101 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11102 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11103 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11104 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11105 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11106 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11107 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11108 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11110 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11111 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11112 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11113 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11114 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11115 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11116 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11117 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11120 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11121 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11122 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11123 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11125 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11126 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11127 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11128 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11131 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11133 This variable contains the current process id.
11135 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11136 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11137 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11138 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11139 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11140 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11141 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11142 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11143 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11144 variable"& error if encountered.
11146 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11147 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11148 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11149 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11150 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11151 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11152 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11155 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11156 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11157 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11158 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11160 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11161 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11162 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11163 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11165 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11166 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11167 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11168 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11170 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11171 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11172 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11174 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11175 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11176 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11177 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11179 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11180 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11181 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11182 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11183 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11185 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11186 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11187 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11188 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11189 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11190 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11192 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11193 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11194 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11195 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11196 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11198 .vitem &$received_count$&
11199 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11200 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11201 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11202 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11205 .vitem &$received_for$&
11206 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11207 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11208 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11209 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11210 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11212 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11213 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11214 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11215 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11216 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11217 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11218 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11221 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11222 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11223 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11224 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11225 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11228 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11229 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11230 &(smtp)& transport).
11232 .vitem &$received_port$&
11233 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11234 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11236 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11237 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11238 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11239 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11240 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11241 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11242 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11243 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11244 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11246 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11247 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11248 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11249 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11250 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11251 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11253 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11254 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11255 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11257 .vitem &$received_time$&
11258 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11259 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11260 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11262 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11263 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11264 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11265 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11266 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11268 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11269 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11271 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11272 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11273 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11274 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11276 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11277 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11278 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11279 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11282 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11283 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11286 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11289 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11290 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11294 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11297 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11300 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11301 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11303 .vitem &$recipients$&
11304 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11305 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11306 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11307 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11308 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11312 In a system filter file.
11314 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11315 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11316 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11317 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11319 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11323 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11324 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11325 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11326 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11327 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11328 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11331 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11332 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11333 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11334 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11337 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11338 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11339 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11340 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11341 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11342 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11343 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11345 .vitem &$return_path$&
11346 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11347 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11348 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11349 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11350 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11351 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11352 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11353 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11354 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11355 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11358 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11359 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11360 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11363 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11364 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11365 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11366 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11367 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11368 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11369 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11372 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11373 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11374 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11375 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11376 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11377 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11378 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11379 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11381 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11382 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11383 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11384 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11385 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11386 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11388 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11389 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11390 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11391 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11392 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11393 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11394 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11395 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11397 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11398 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11399 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11401 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11402 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11403 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11405 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11406 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11407 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11408 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11409 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11412 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11413 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11415 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11416 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11417 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11418 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11420 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11421 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11422 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11423 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11424 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11425 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11426 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11427 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11428 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11429 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11430 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11431 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11432 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11434 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11435 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11436 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11437 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11438 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11439 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11441 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11442 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11443 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11444 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11446 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11447 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11448 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11449 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11450 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11451 &$authenticated_id$&.
11453 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11454 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11455 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11456 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11457 other means, this variable is empty.
11459 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11460 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11461 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11462 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11463 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11464 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11465 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11467 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11468 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11469 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11470 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11472 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11473 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11474 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11477 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11478 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11479 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11480 following are true:
11483 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11485 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11486 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11487 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11489 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11490 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11491 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11493 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11494 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11495 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11497 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11498 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11499 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11500 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11502 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11504 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11505 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11509 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11510 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11511 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11512 number that was used on the remote host.
11514 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11515 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11516 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11517 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11518 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11521 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11522 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11523 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11524 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11526 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11527 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11528 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11529 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11530 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11531 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11532 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11533 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11534 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11535 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11536 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11539 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11540 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11541 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11542 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11543 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11545 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11546 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11547 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11548 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11549 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11551 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11552 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11553 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11554 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11555 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11556 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11557 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11559 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11560 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11561 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11562 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11563 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11565 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11566 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11567 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11568 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11569 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11570 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11572 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11573 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11574 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11575 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11576 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11581 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11582 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11583 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11584 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11586 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11587 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11588 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11589 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11590 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11591 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11592 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11594 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11595 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11596 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11597 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11598 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11599 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11600 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11601 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11602 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11603 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11604 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11606 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11607 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11608 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11609 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11610 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11611 message is junk mail.
11613 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11614 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11615 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11616 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11619 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11620 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11621 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11623 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11624 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11625 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11626 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11627 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11628 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11630 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11631 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11632 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11633 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11634 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11635 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11636 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11637 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11639 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11641 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11644 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11645 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11646 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11647 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11648 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11649 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11651 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11652 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11653 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11654 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11656 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11657 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11658 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11659 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11660 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11661 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11662 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11663 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11665 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11666 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11667 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11668 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11669 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11670 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11672 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11673 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11674 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11675 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11676 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11677 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11678 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11681 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11682 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11683 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11684 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11686 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11687 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11688 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11690 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11691 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11692 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11693 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11694 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11695 values for those that are behind (west).
11698 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11699 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11700 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11702 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11703 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11704 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11705 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11708 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11709 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11710 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11713 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11714 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11715 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11716 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11719 .vindex "&$value$&"
11720 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11721 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11722 &*reduce*& expansion.
11724 .vitem &$version_number$&
11725 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11726 The version number of Exim.
11728 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11729 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11730 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11731 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11733 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11734 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11735 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11736 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11745 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11746 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11747 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11748 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11749 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11750 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11755 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11758 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11759 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11760 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11761 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11762 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11763 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11764 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11765 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11766 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11768 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11769 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11770 should usually be something like
11772 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11774 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11775 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11776 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11777 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11778 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11779 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11780 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11781 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11785 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11786 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11787 a startup when Exim is entered.
11789 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11790 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11793 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11794 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11797 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11798 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11799 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11800 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11804 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
11805 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11807 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11808 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11809 with an error message of the form
11811 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11813 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11814 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11815 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11816 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11817 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11818 that was passed to &%die%&.
11821 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11822 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11823 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11826 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11828 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11829 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11830 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11832 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11833 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11834 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11835 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11837 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11838 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11839 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11840 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11841 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11842 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11843 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11846 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11847 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11848 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11849 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11850 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11851 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11852 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11853 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11854 avoided, but the output is lost.
11856 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11857 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11858 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11859 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11860 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11861 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11862 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11864 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11866 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11867 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11868 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11869 as the first subroutine argument.
11873 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11874 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11876 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11877 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11878 "Starting the daemon"
11879 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
11880 .cindex "interface" "listening"
11881 .cindex "network interface"
11882 .cindex "interface" "network"
11883 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11884 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11885 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11886 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11887 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11888 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11889 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11890 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11891 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11892 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11893 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11896 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11897 and ports to listen on.
11899 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
11900 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
11901 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
11902 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
11903 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
11904 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
11905 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
11906 as an error situation.
11908 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
11909 for the outgoing connection.
11913 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
11914 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
11915 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
11916 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
11917 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
11919 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
11920 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
11921 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
11922 chapter describes how they operate.
11924 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
11925 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
11929 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
11930 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
11931 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
11935 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
11936 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
11938 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
11939 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
11942 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
11943 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
11944 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
11945 colons. For example:
11947 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
11950 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
11952 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
11953 in &%local_interfaces%&:
11956 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
11957 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
11959 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
11960 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
11963 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
11964 with a colon separator, for example:
11966 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
11967 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
11971 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
11972 default setting contains just one port:
11974 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
11976 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
11977 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
11978 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
11979 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
11980 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
11984 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
11985 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
11986 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
11987 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
11988 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
11989 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11991 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
11993 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
11995 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
11997 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12001 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12002 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12003 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12004 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12005 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12006 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12009 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12010 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12011 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12012 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12013 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12014 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12018 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12021 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12023 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12024 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12025 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12029 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12030 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12031 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12032 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12033 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12034 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12035 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12036 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12037 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12038 common use of this option is expected to be
12040 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12042 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12043 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12044 this way when a daemon is started.
12046 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12047 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12048 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12049 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12050 connections via the daemon.)
12055 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12056 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12057 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12058 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12059 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12060 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12061 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12062 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12064 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12066 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12067 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12068 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12069 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12070 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12071 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12073 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12075 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12076 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12077 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12078 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12079 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12081 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12082 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12083 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12084 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12085 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12086 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12087 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12088 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12089 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12090 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12091 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12092 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12094 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12095 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12096 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12097 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12098 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12102 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12103 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12105 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12106 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12108 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12109 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12110 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12111 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12113 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12115 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12117 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12119 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12120 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12122 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12123 IPv4 loopback address only:
12125 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12127 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12129 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12131 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12135 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12136 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12137 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12138 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12141 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12142 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12143 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12144 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12146 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12147 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12148 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12149 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12150 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12151 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12152 used for listening. Consider this example:
12154 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12156 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12158 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12160 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12161 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12164 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12165 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12166 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12167 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12168 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12169 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12170 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12171 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12175 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12176 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12177 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12178 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12179 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12180 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12187 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12189 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12190 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12191 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12192 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12195 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12196 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12198 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12199 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12200 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12202 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12203 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12204 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12205 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12209 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12210 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12211 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12212 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12213 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12214 listed in more than one group.
12216 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12218 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12219 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12220 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12221 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12222 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12223 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12224 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12225 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12226 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12230 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12232 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12233 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12234 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12235 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12236 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12237 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12242 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12244 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12245 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12246 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12247 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12248 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12249 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12250 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12251 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12252 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12253 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12254 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12259 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12261 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12262 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12263 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12264 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12265 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12266 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12267 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12268 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12269 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12270 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12271 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12272 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12277 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12279 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12280 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12281 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12282 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12287 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12289 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12290 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12291 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12292 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12293 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12294 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12295 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12296 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12301 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12303 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12304 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12309 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12311 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12312 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12317 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12319 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12320 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12321 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12322 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12323 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12324 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12325 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12330 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12332 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12333 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12334 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12335 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12336 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12337 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12338 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12339 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12340 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12341 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12342 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12343 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12344 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12345 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12346 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12347 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12349 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12350 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12351 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12352 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12353 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12358 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12360 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12361 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12362 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12363 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12364 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12365 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12366 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12367 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12368 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12369 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12370 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12371 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12372 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12373 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12374 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12375 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12376 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12377 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12378 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12380 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12381 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12382 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12383 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12384 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12385 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12386 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12387 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12388 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12389 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12390 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12391 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12392 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12393 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12394 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12395 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12396 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12397 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12402 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12404 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12406 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12408 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12409 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12410 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12415 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12417 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12418 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12419 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12420 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12421 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12422 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12423 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12424 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12425 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12426 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12427 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12428 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12429 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12430 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12431 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12432 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12437 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12439 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12440 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12441 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12442 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12443 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12444 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12445 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12446 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12451 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12453 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12454 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12455 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12456 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12457 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12458 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12459 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12460 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12466 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12468 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12475 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12476 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12479 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12480 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12481 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12482 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12483 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12484 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12485 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12486 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12487 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12488 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12489 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12490 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12491 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12492 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12494 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12495 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12496 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12497 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12498 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12499 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12500 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12501 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12502 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12503 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12504 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12505 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12506 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12507 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12508 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12509 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12514 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12516 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12517 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12518 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12519 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12520 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12521 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12526 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12528 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12529 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12530 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12531 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12533 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12534 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12535 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12536 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12537 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12538 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12539 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12540 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12541 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12542 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12547 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12549 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12550 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12552 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12553 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12554 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12555 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12556 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12561 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12563 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12564 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12565 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12566 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12567 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12568 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12569 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12570 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12571 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12572 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12573 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12574 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12575 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12576 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12577 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12578 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12579 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12580 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12581 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12582 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12583 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12588 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12590 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12591 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12592 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12593 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12594 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12595 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12596 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12597 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12598 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12599 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12600 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12601 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12602 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12603 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12608 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12609 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12612 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12614 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12615 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12616 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12617 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12618 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12619 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12621 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12622 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12623 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12624 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12625 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12628 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12629 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12630 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12633 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12634 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12635 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12636 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12637 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12639 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12640 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12641 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12642 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12643 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12645 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12646 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12647 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12648 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12650 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12651 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12652 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12653 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12654 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12656 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12657 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12658 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12659 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12661 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12662 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12663 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12664 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12666 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12667 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12668 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12669 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12670 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12673 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12674 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12675 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12676 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12678 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12679 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12680 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12681 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12682 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12684 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12685 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12686 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12687 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12688 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12690 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12691 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12692 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12695 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12696 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12697 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12698 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12700 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12701 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12702 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12703 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12705 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12706 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12707 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12708 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12710 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12711 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12712 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12713 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12715 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12716 .cindex "admin user"
12717 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12718 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12719 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12720 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12721 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12722 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12723 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12725 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12726 .cindex "domain literal"
12727 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12728 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12729 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12730 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12732 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12733 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12734 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12735 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12736 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12737 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12738 the local host's IP addresses.
12741 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12742 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12743 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12744 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12745 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12746 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12747 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12748 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12749 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12751 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12752 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12753 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12754 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12755 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12756 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12757 experiment if they wish.
12759 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12760 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12761 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12762 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12763 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12764 suitable setting is:
12766 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12767 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12769 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12771 dns_check_names_pattern =
12773 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12776 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12777 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12778 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12779 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12780 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12781 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12782 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12783 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12784 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12785 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12786 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12788 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12789 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12790 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12791 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12792 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12793 which Exim advertises AUTH.
12795 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12796 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12797 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12798 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12800 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12802 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12803 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12804 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12805 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12808 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
12809 .cindex "thawing messages"
12810 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
12811 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12812 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12813 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12814 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12815 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12817 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12818 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12819 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12821 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
12822 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12823 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12825 sophie:/var/run/sophie
12827 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
12828 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12832 .option bi_command main string unset
12834 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12835 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12836 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12837 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12840 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
12841 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12842 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12843 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12844 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12845 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12848 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
12849 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12850 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12851 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12853 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12854 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12855 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12856 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12857 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12858 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12859 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12860 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12861 point at which the error was detected are returned.
12862 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12864 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12865 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12866 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12867 &%bounce_return_body%&.
12870 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12871 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12872 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12873 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12874 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12875 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12876 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12877 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12878 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12880 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12881 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12882 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12883 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12884 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12887 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12888 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
12889 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
12890 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
12891 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
12892 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
12893 connection. A typical setting might be:
12895 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12897 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
12899 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12901 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
12904 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
12905 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
12906 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
12907 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
12908 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12909 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12912 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
12913 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
12914 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12915 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12918 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
12919 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
12920 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12921 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12924 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
12925 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
12926 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12927 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12930 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
12931 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
12932 callout verification. The default value is
12934 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
12936 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
12939 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
12940 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12943 .option check_log_space main integer 0
12944 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12946 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
12947 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
12948 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
12949 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
12950 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
12951 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
12952 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
12953 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
12954 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
12955 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
12958 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
12959 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12962 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
12963 .cindex "checking disk space"
12964 .cindex "disk space, checking"
12965 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
12966 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
12967 message is accepted.
12969 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12970 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12971 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12972 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12973 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
12974 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
12975 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
12976 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
12979 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
12980 either value is greater than zero, for example:
12982 check_spool_space = 10M
12983 check_spool_inodes = 100
12985 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
12986 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
12989 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
12990 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
12991 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
12993 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
12994 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
12995 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
12996 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
12997 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
12998 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13000 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13001 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13003 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13004 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13005 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13007 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13008 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13009 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13010 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13011 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13012 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13014 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13015 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13016 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13017 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13018 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13019 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13020 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13022 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13023 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13025 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13026 .cindex "warning of delay"
13027 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13028 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13029 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13030 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13031 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13032 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13033 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13036 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13038 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13039 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13040 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13041 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13045 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13046 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13048 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13051 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13052 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13053 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13054 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13055 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13056 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13057 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13058 not sent. The default is:
13060 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13061 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13062 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13063 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13066 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13067 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13068 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13069 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13071 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13072 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13073 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13074 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13075 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13076 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13077 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13078 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13080 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13081 .cindex "load average"
13082 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13083 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13084 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13085 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13086 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13089 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13090 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13091 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13092 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13093 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13094 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13095 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13096 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13098 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13099 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13100 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13101 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13102 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13103 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13104 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13105 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13107 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13108 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13109 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13110 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13113 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13114 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13115 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13116 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13117 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13118 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13119 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13122 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13123 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13124 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13125 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13126 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13127 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13128 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13129 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13130 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13131 by a setting such as this:
13133 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13135 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13136 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13137 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13138 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13139 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13140 options are applied after this global option.
13142 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13143 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13144 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13145 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13146 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13147 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13148 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13149 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13150 value of this option. The default pattern is
13152 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13153 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13155 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13156 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13157 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13158 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13159 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13162 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13163 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13164 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13166 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13167 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13168 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13169 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13171 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13172 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13173 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13174 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13175 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13176 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13177 domain matches this list.
13179 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13180 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13181 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13184 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13185 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13186 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13187 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13188 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13189 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13190 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13191 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13192 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13193 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13197 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13198 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13201 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13202 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13203 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13204 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13206 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13207 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13208 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13209 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13210 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13211 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13213 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13215 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13216 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13218 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13219 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13220 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13221 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13222 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13223 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13224 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13225 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13226 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13229 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13230 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13231 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13232 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13233 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13234 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13235 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13236 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13237 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13239 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13240 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13241 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13242 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13243 are examined. For example:
13245 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13246 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13247 postmaster@mydomain.example
13249 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13250 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13251 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13252 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13253 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13254 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13255 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13258 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13259 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13260 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13262 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13264 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13265 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13266 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13267 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13268 overrides the default.
13270 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13271 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13272 and warning messages. For example:
13274 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13276 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13277 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13278 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13279 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13283 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13284 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13285 .cindex "Exim group"
13286 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13287 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13288 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13289 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13290 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13294 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13295 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13296 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13297 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13298 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13299 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13301 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13302 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13303 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13304 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13307 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13308 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13309 .cindex "Exim user"
13310 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13311 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13312 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13313 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13315 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13316 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13317 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13318 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13321 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13322 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13323 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13324 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13327 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13328 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13330 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13331 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13333 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13334 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13335 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13336 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13337 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13338 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13339 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13340 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13341 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13342 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13346 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13347 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13348 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13349 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13350 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13351 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13352 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13353 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13356 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13357 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13358 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13359 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13363 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13364 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13365 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13366 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13367 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13368 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13369 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13370 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13371 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13372 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13373 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13374 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13375 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13376 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13377 logging that you require.
13380 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13382 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13383 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13384 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13385 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13386 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13387 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13388 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13389 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13391 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13392 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13393 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13396 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13397 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13398 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13399 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13401 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13405 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13406 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13409 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13410 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13411 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13413 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13414 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13415 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13417 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13418 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13419 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13421 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13422 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13423 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13424 implementations of TLS.
13426 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13427 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13428 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13429 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13430 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13431 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13435 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13436 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13437 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13438 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13439 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13440 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13441 sections are rejected.
13444 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13445 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13446 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13447 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13448 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13449 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13450 zero means &"no limit"&.
13455 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13456 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13457 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13458 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13459 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13460 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13461 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13462 if you want to do semantic checking.
13463 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13467 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13468 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13469 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13470 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13471 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13472 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13473 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13475 helo_allow_chars = _
13477 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13480 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13481 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13482 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13483 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13484 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13485 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13486 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13490 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13491 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13492 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13493 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13494 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13495 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13496 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13497 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13498 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13499 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13500 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13501 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13503 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13504 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13505 EHLO command either:
13508 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13510 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13511 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13512 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13513 calling host address, or
13515 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13516 available) yields the calling host address.
13519 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13520 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13521 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13523 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13524 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13525 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13526 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13527 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13528 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13529 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13530 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13531 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13534 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13535 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13536 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13537 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13538 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13539 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13540 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13541 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13542 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13544 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13545 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13546 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13547 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13548 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13550 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13551 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13552 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13553 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13556 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13557 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13558 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13559 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13560 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13561 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13562 default configuration file contains
13566 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13567 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13569 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13570 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13571 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13573 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13574 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13575 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13576 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13577 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13578 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13581 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13582 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13583 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13584 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13585 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13588 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13589 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13590 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13591 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13595 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13596 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13597 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13598 as soon as the connection is made.
13599 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13600 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13601 connections immediately.
13603 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13604 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13605 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13606 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13607 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13610 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13611 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13612 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13613 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13614 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13615 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13616 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13617 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13618 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13620 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13622 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13626 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13627 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13628 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13629 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13630 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13632 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13633 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13635 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13636 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13637 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13638 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13639 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13640 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13641 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13644 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13645 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13646 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13647 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13648 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13652 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13653 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13654 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13655 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13656 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13657 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13659 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13660 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13661 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13662 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13663 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13664 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13665 for frozen messages. For example,
13667 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13669 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13670 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13671 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13672 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13673 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13674 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13677 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13678 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13679 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13680 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13681 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13682 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13683 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13684 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13685 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13686 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13689 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13690 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13693 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13694 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13695 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13696 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13700 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13701 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13702 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13703 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13704 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13708 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13709 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13710 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13711 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13712 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13713 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13714 has been built with LDAP support.
13718 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13719 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13720 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13721 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13722 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13723 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13724 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13726 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13727 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13728 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13730 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13731 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13732 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13733 and the default qualify domain.
13735 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13736 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13737 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13738 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13740 .cindex "envelope sender"
13741 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13742 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13743 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13745 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13746 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13747 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13752 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
13753 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13754 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13755 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13756 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13757 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13758 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13761 local_from_prefix = *-
13763 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13765 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13767 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13768 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13772 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
13773 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13776 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13777 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13778 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13779 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13780 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13781 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13782 &%local_interfaces%& is
13784 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13786 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13788 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13791 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13792 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13793 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13794 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13795 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13796 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13797 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13798 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13802 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13803 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13804 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13805 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13806 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13807 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13808 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13809 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13814 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13815 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13816 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
13817 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13818 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
13819 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
13820 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
13821 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
13822 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
13823 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
13824 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
13825 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
13826 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
13827 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
13828 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
13832 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
13833 .cindex "log" "file path for"
13834 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
13835 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
13836 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
13837 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
13838 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
13839 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
13840 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
13841 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
13842 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
13843 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
13844 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
13845 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
13848 .option log_selector main string unset
13849 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13850 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
13851 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
13852 minus characters. For example:
13854 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
13856 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
13857 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
13860 .option log_timezone main boolean false
13861 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
13862 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13863 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13864 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
13865 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
13866 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
13867 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
13868 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
13869 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
13870 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
13871 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
13872 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
13875 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
13876 .cindex "too many open files"
13877 .cindex "open files, too many"
13878 .cindex "file" "too many open"
13879 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
13880 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
13881 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
13882 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
13883 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
13884 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
13885 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
13886 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
13887 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
13888 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
13889 &%lookup_open_max%&.
13892 .option max_username_length main integer 0
13893 .cindex "length of login name"
13894 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
13895 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
13896 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
13897 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
13898 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
13899 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
13902 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
13903 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
13904 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
13905 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13906 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13907 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
13908 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
13909 option is set true, this no longer happens.
13912 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
13913 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
13914 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
13915 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13916 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13917 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
13918 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
13921 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
13922 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
13923 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
13924 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
13925 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
13926 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
13927 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
13928 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
13929 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
13930 empty string, the option is ignored.
13933 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
13934 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
13935 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
13936 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
13937 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
13938 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
13939 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
13940 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
13941 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
13942 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
13943 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
13944 colons will become hyphens.
13947 .option message_logs main boolean true
13948 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
13949 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
13950 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13951 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13952 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13953 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13954 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13955 which is not affected by this option.
13958 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
13959 .cindex "message" "size limit"
13960 .cindex "limit" "message size"
13961 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
13962 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13963 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
13964 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
13965 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
13966 optionally followed by K or M.
13968 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
13969 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
13970 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
13971 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
13972 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
13974 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
13975 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
13976 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
13977 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
13978 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
13979 message that an individual transport can process.
13981 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
13982 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
13983 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
13984 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
13985 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
13986 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
13987 some problems may result.
13990 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
13991 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
13992 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
13994 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
13996 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
13997 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
13998 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
13999 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14000 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14003 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14004 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14005 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14006 contains a full description of this facility.
14010 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14011 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14012 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14013 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14014 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14017 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14018 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14019 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14020 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14021 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14024 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14025 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14026 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14027 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14028 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14030 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14031 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14034 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14036 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14037 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14041 .option openssl_options main "string list" +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14042 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14043 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14044 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14045 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value. The default
14046 value is one option which happens to have been set historically. You can
14047 remove all options with:
14049 openssl_options = -all
14051 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14052 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14053 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14054 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14055 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14056 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14057 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14059 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14060 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14061 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14062 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at by invoking Exim
14063 with the &%-bV%& flag.
14067 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer
14071 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14072 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14073 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14074 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14075 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14078 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14079 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14080 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14081 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14082 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14083 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14084 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14085 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14086 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14087 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14090 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14091 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14092 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14093 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14094 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14095 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14096 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14099 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14100 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14101 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14104 .option perl_startup main string unset
14105 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14106 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14109 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14110 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14111 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14112 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14113 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14114 PostgreSQL support.
14117 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14118 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14119 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14120 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14121 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14124 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14126 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14128 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14129 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14130 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14133 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14134 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14135 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14136 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14137 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14138 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14139 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14140 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14141 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14144 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14145 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14146 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14147 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14148 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14149 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14150 volume of mail. Use with care!
14153 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14154 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14155 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14156 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14157 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14158 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14159 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14160 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14161 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14162 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14164 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14165 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14166 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14167 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14168 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14169 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14172 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14173 .cindex "printing characters"
14174 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14175 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14176 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14177 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14178 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14179 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14182 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14183 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14184 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14185 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14186 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14190 .option process_log_path main string unset
14191 .cindex "process log path"
14192 .cindex "log" "process log"
14193 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14194 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14195 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14196 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14197 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14198 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14199 different spool directories.
14202 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14206 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14207 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14208 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14211 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14212 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14213 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14214 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14215 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14216 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14217 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14218 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14219 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14221 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14222 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14223 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14224 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14225 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14226 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14227 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14230 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14231 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14232 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14236 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14237 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14238 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14239 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14240 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14241 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14242 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14243 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14246 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14248 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14249 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14250 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14253 .option queue_only main boolean false
14254 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14255 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14256 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14257 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14258 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14259 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14261 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14262 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14263 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14264 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14267 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14268 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14269 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14270 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14271 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14272 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14273 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14274 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14275 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14277 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14279 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14280 &_/some/file_& exists.
14283 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14284 .cindex "load average"
14285 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14286 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14287 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14288 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14289 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14290 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14291 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14294 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14295 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14296 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14297 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14300 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14301 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14302 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14303 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14304 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14305 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14306 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14307 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14308 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14309 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14310 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14311 re-evaluated for each message.
14314 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14315 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14316 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14317 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14318 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14319 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14322 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14323 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14324 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14325 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14326 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14327 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14328 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14329 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14330 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14331 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14332 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14333 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14334 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14338 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14339 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14340 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14341 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14342 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14343 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14344 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14345 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14346 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14348 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14349 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14350 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14351 the daemon's command line.
14353 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14354 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14355 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14356 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14357 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14358 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14359 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14360 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14361 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14362 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14363 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14364 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14365 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14369 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14370 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14371 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14372 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14373 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14374 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14375 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14377 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14378 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14379 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14380 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14381 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14382 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14383 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14384 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14385 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14386 header lines. The default setting is:
14389 received_header_text = Received: \
14390 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14391 {${if def:sender_ident \
14392 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14393 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14394 by $primary_hostname \
14395 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14396 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14397 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14398 ${if def:sender_address \
14399 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14400 id $message_exim_id\
14401 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14404 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14405 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14406 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14407 header lines such as the following:
14409 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14410 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14411 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14412 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14413 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14414 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14415 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14417 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14418 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14419 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14420 message was accepted.
14423 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14424 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14425 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14426 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14427 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14428 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14429 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14430 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14433 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14434 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14435 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14436 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14437 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14438 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14439 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14440 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14441 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14442 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14443 option was not set.
14446 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14447 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14448 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14449 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14450 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14451 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14452 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14453 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14456 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14457 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14458 RCPT commands in a single message.
14461 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14462 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14463 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14464 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14465 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14466 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14467 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14470 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14471 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14472 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14473 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14474 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14475 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14476 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14477 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14478 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14479 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14480 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14481 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14482 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14483 tagged with its process id.
14485 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14486 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14487 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14488 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14491 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14492 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14493 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14494 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14495 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14496 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14497 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14498 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14499 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14500 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14501 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14503 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14504 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14505 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14506 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14509 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14510 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14511 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14512 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14513 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14515 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14517 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14518 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14521 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14522 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14523 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14524 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14525 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14529 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14530 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14531 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14532 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14533 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14534 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14535 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14539 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14540 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14541 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14542 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14543 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14544 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14545 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14546 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14547 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14548 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14551 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14552 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14555 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14557 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14558 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14561 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14562 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14563 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14564 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14565 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14568 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14569 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14570 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14571 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14572 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14573 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14574 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14575 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14576 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14577 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14580 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14581 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14582 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14583 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14584 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14585 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14586 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14587 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14588 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14589 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14590 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14594 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14595 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14596 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14598 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14599 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14600 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14601 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14602 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14603 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14605 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14606 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14607 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14608 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14611 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14612 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14613 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14614 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14615 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14616 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14617 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14618 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14620 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14621 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14622 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14623 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14624 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14625 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14626 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14627 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14630 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14631 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14632 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14633 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14637 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14638 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14640 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14641 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14642 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14643 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14644 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14645 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14646 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14647 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14648 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14652 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14653 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14654 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14655 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14656 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14657 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14658 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14659 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14660 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14661 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14662 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14664 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14665 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14666 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14667 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14668 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14669 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14673 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14674 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14675 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14676 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14677 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14678 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14679 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14680 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14681 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14682 to all messages received in the same connection.
14684 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14685 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14686 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14687 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14690 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14691 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14693 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14694 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14695 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14696 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14697 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14698 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14699 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14700 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14701 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14702 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14703 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14704 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14705 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14708 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14709 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14710 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14711 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14712 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14713 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14714 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14715 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14716 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14717 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14718 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14721 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14722 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14723 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14724 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14727 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14728 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14729 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14730 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14731 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14732 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14733 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14734 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14735 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14737 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14738 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14739 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14740 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14742 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14743 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14744 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14745 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14746 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14749 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14750 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14753 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14754 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14755 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14756 &%helo_data%& value.
14758 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14759 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14760 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
14761 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14762 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14763 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14764 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14766 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14767 $version_number $tod_full
14769 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14770 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14771 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14772 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14773 multiline response).
14776 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14777 .cindex "checking disk space"
14778 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14779 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14780 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14781 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14782 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14783 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14784 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14787 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14788 .cindex "connection backlog"
14789 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14790 .cindex "backlog of connections"
14791 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14792 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14793 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14794 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14795 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14796 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14797 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14798 attacks by SYN flooding.
14801 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14802 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14803 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14804 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14805 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14806 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14807 fewer, but they still exist.
14809 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14810 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14811 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14812 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
14813 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
14814 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
14815 does detect many instances.
14817 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
14818 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14819 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
14820 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
14824 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
14825 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
14826 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14827 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14828 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14829 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
14830 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
14831 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14834 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
14835 $sender_host_address
14837 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14838 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14839 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14840 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14841 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14845 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
14846 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
14847 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14848 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14849 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
14852 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
14853 .cindex "load average"
14854 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14855 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
14856 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14857 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14858 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14859 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
14863 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
14864 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
14865 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
14866 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14867 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14869 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14871 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14872 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14873 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14874 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14875 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14877 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
14878 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14879 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14880 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14881 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
14882 not count towards the limit.
14886 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
14887 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
14888 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
14889 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14890 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14893 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14894 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14898 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14899 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
14900 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
14901 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
14902 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14903 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14906 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
14907 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
14908 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
14909 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
14911 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
14912 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
14913 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14914 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14918 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14920 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14921 fractional parts are allowed here.
14923 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14925 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14926 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14929 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14930 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14932 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14933 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14935 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14936 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14937 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14938 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14941 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
14942 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14945 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
14946 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14949 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
14950 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
14951 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
14952 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14953 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14954 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14955 the message is abandoned.
14956 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14958 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14959 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14961 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14962 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
14966 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
14967 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
14968 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
14969 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
14970 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
14973 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14974 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
14975 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
14978 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
14979 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
14980 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
14981 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
14982 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
14983 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
14984 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
14985 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
14986 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
14987 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
14989 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
14990 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
14993 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
14994 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
14995 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
14996 The default value is
15000 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15004 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15005 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15006 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15007 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15008 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15009 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15010 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15011 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15012 arrival of the message.
15014 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15015 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15016 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15017 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15018 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15020 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15021 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15022 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15023 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15024 automatically deleted.
15026 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15027 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15028 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15029 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15030 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15031 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15032 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15033 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15034 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15037 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15038 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15039 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15040 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15041 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15042 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15043 &$primary_hostname$&.
15045 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15046 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15047 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15048 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15049 as failures in the configuration file.
15051 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15052 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15054 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15055 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15056 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15057 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15059 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15060 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15061 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15062 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15063 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15064 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15066 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15067 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15068 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15069 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15070 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15071 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15072 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15075 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15076 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15077 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15078 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15079 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15080 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15081 domain causes a syntax error.
15082 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15086 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15087 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15088 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15089 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15090 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15091 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15092 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15093 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15094 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15095 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15096 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15097 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15100 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15101 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15102 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15103 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15104 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15105 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15106 details of Exim's logging.
15110 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15111 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15112 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15113 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15114 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15118 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15119 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15120 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15121 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15122 details of Exim's logging.
15125 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15126 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15127 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15128 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15129 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15130 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15131 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15132 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15133 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15134 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15135 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15138 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15139 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15140 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15141 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15142 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15143 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15146 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15147 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15148 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15149 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15150 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15152 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15153 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15154 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15155 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15156 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15158 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15159 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15160 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15161 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15162 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15163 contains the pipe command.
15166 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15167 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15168 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15169 is used in a system filter.
15171 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15172 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15173 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
15174 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
15175 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15176 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15177 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15178 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15179 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15181 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15182 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15183 transport option overrides. Normally you should set &%system_filter_user%& if
15184 your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
15187 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15188 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15189 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15190 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15191 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15192 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15193 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15194 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15195 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15196 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15197 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15198 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15202 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15203 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15204 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15205 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15206 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15207 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15208 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15209 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15210 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15211 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15213 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15214 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15215 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15218 .option timezone main string unset
15219 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15220 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15221 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15222 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15223 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15227 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15228 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15229 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15230 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15231 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15232 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15235 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15236 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15237 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15238 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15239 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15240 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15241 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15242 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15245 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15246 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15247 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15248 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15249 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15250 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15251 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15253 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15254 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15255 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15256 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15259 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15260 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15261 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15262 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15263 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15266 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15267 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15268 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15269 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15270 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15271 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15274 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15275 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15276 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15277 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15278 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15282 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15283 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15284 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15285 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15286 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15287 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15288 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15291 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15292 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15293 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15294 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15295 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15296 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15300 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15301 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15302 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15303 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15304 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15305 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15306 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15307 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15308 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15309 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15310 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15313 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15314 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15315 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15316 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15319 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15320 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15321 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15322 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15323 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15324 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15325 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15326 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15327 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15330 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15331 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15332 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15333 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15334 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15335 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15336 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15337 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15339 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15340 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15341 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15342 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15343 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15344 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15345 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15347 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15348 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15349 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15350 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15351 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15352 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15353 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15356 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15360 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15361 .cindex "trusted groups"
15362 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15363 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15364 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15365 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15366 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15367 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15368 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15371 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15372 .cindex "trusted users"
15373 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15374 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15375 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15376 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15377 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15378 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15379 Exim user are trusted.
15381 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15382 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15383 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15384 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15385 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15386 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15387 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15388 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15389 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15392 .option unknown_username main string unset
15393 See &%unknown_login%&.
15395 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15396 .cindex "trusted users"
15397 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15398 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15399 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15400 .cindex "envelope sender"
15401 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15402 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15403 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15404 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15405 is used) is ignored.
15407 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15408 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15410 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15412 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15413 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15414 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15415 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15416 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15417 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15418 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15419 followed by a hyphen
15420 by a setting like this:
15422 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15424 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15425 restriction, you can use
15427 untrusted_set_sender = *
15429 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15430 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15431 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15432 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15433 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15434 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15435 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15436 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15438 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15439 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15440 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15441 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15445 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15446 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15447 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15448 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15449 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15450 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15451 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15452 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15453 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15454 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15456 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15457 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15459 The pattern can be seen by running
15461 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15463 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15464 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15465 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15466 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15467 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15468 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15471 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15472 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15475 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15476 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15477 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15478 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15479 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15480 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15481 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15482 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15485 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15486 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15487 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15488 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15489 .ecindex IIDconfima
15490 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15495 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15496 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15498 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15499 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15500 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15501 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15502 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
15504 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15505 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15506 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15507 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15508 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15512 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15513 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15514 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15515 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15516 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15517 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15518 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15520 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15521 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15522 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15523 routers, and the eventual transport.
15525 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15526 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15527 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15528 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15529 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15531 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15532 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15533 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15534 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15535 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15537 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15538 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15539 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15541 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15543 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15545 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15547 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15548 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15550 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15551 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15552 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15553 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15554 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15555 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15556 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15560 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15562 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15563 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15564 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15565 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15566 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15571 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15572 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15573 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15574 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15575 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15576 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15577 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15578 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15579 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15580 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15583 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15585 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15588 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15590 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15591 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15592 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15593 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15596 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15597 .cindex "case of local parts"
15598 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15599 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15600 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15601 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15602 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15603 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15604 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15607 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15608 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15609 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15610 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15611 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15612 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15613 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15614 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15615 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15617 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15618 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15619 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15620 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15624 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15625 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15626 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15627 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15629 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15630 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15631 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15632 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15633 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15634 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15635 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15636 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15637 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15638 the router is skipped.
15640 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15641 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15642 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15643 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15644 setting to achieve this. For example:
15646 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15648 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15649 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15650 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15654 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15655 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15656 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15657 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15658 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15659 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15660 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15661 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15663 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15664 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15666 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15667 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15668 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15670 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15672 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15674 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15676 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15677 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15678 be specified using &%condition%&.
15682 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15683 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15684 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15685 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15686 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15687 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15688 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15689 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15690 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15691 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15692 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15693 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15697 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
15698 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15699 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15700 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15701 transport option of the same name.
15704 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15705 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15706 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15707 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15708 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15709 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15710 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15711 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15715 .option driver routers string unset
15716 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15721 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15722 .cindex "envelope sender"
15723 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15724 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15725 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15726 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15727 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15728 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15729 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15731 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15732 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15733 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15736 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15737 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15738 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15739 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15741 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15742 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15743 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15744 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15750 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15751 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15752 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15753 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15754 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15756 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15757 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15758 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15759 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15760 setting &%return_path%&.
15762 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15763 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15764 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15768 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
15769 .cindex "address" "testing"
15770 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
15771 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15772 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15773 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15774 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15775 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15776 on for the system alias file.
15777 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15780 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15781 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15782 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15786 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
15787 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15788 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15789 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15793 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15794 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15795 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15799 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
15800 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15801 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15805 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
15806 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
15807 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
15808 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15809 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
15810 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
15811 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
15812 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
15813 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
15815 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
15816 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
15817 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
15818 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
15819 transport for further details.
15822 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
15823 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
15824 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15825 .cindex "transport" "local"
15826 .cindex "router" "setting group"
15827 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15828 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15830 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15831 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15832 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
15833 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
15834 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15838 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
15839 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
15840 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
15841 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15842 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15843 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15844 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15845 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
15846 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
15847 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
15848 &"see"& the added header lines.
15850 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
15851 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
15852 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
15853 failures are treated as configuration errors.
15855 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15856 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15858 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
15859 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
15860 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15861 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
15862 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
15863 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
15864 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
15865 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
15866 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
15867 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
15871 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
15872 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
15873 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
15874 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15875 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15876 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15877 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15878 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
15879 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
15880 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
15881 &"see"& the original header lines.
15883 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
15884 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15885 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
15888 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15889 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15891 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15892 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
15893 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
15894 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
15897 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
15898 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
15899 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
15900 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15901 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15902 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15903 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15906 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15910 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15912 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
15913 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15914 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
15915 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15916 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
15917 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15919 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
15920 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
15922 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
15923 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
15925 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
15926 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
15928 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15929 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
15930 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15931 domain that is being routed.
15933 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
15934 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
15937 .option initgroups routers boolean false
15938 .cindex "additional groups"
15939 .cindex "groups" "additional"
15940 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15941 .cindex "transport" "local"
15942 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15943 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15944 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15945 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
15946 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15950 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
15951 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
15952 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
15953 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
15954 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
15955 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
15958 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
15959 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
15960 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
15961 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
15962 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
15963 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
15964 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
15965 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
15966 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
15968 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15969 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
15970 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
15971 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
15972 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
15973 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
15974 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
15975 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
15976 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
15977 the relevant transport.
15979 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
15980 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
15981 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
15984 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
15985 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
15986 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
15987 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
15988 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
15992 local_part_prefix = real-
15994 transport = local_delivery
15996 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
15997 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
15999 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16000 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16003 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16004 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16005 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16006 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16009 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16010 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16014 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16015 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16016 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16017 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16018 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16019 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16020 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16021 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16022 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16026 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16027 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16031 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16032 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16033 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16034 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16035 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16037 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16038 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16041 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16043 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16044 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16045 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16046 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16047 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16048 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16049 each virtual domain:
16053 local_parts = postmaster
16054 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16058 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16059 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16060 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16061 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16062 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16063 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16064 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16065 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16066 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16067 redirect addresses.
16071 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16072 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16073 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16074 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16075 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16076 delivery to be deferred.
16078 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16079 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16081 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16082 means of the setting
16086 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16087 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16088 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16090 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16091 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16092 controls what happens next.
16095 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16096 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16097 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16098 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16099 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16100 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16101 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16102 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16104 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16105 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16106 applies to all of them.
16110 .option pass_router routers string unset
16111 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16112 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16113 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16114 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16115 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16116 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16117 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16118 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16119 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16120 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16124 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16125 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16126 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16127 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16128 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16129 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16131 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16132 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16133 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16134 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16138 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16139 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16140 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16141 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16142 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16143 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16144 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16146 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16147 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16148 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16149 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16151 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16152 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16153 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16154 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16155 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16158 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16159 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16162 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16163 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16164 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16165 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16166 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16167 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16168 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16169 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16171 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16172 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16173 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16174 operates as follows:
16176 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16177 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16178 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16179 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16182 require_files = mail:/some/file
16183 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16185 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16186 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16188 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16189 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16190 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16191 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16193 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16194 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16195 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16196 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16197 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16199 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16200 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16201 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16202 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16203 check again in that process.
16205 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16206 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16207 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16208 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16209 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16210 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16211 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16213 require_files = +/some/file
16215 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16216 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16217 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16221 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16222 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16223 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16224 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16225 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16226 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16227 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16228 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16231 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16232 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16233 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16234 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16235 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16238 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16239 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16240 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16244 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16245 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16246 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16248 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16249 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16250 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16251 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16252 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16253 cause the router to defer.
16255 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16256 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16258 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16260 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16261 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16263 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16264 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16265 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16266 of these values that is set:
16269 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16271 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16273 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16275 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16278 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16279 router, but not for the transport.
16283 .option self routers string freeze
16284 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16285 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16286 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16287 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16288 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16289 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16291 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16292 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16293 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16294 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16295 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16297 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16298 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16299 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16300 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16301 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16306 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16308 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16309 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16310 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16311 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16313 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16314 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16315 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16320 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16321 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16322 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16323 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16324 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16325 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16331 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16332 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16333 be passed to the next router.
16336 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16339 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16340 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16341 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16342 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16343 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16344 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16349 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16350 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16351 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16352 address matches something on the list.
16353 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16356 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16357 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16358 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16359 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16360 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16361 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16362 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16366 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16367 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16368 .cindex "packet radio"
16369 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16370 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16371 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16372 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16373 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16374 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16375 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16376 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16378 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16379 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16380 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16381 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16382 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16383 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16384 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16385 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16386 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16387 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16389 translate_ip_address = \
16390 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16393 The file would contain lines like
16395 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16396 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16398 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16403 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16404 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16405 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16406 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16407 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16408 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16409 delivery is deferred.
16411 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16412 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16413 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16417 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16418 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16419 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16420 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16421 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16422 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16423 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16424 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16425 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16426 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16427 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16433 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16434 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16435 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16436 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16437 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16438 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16439 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16440 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16441 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16442 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16444 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16445 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16446 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16447 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16448 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16450 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16456 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16457 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16458 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16459 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16460 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16461 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16462 delivery to be deferred.
16464 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16465 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16466 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16467 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16468 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16469 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16471 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16472 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16473 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16474 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16475 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16476 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16477 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16478 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16480 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16481 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16482 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16483 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16484 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16485 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16486 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16487 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16488 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16489 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16491 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16492 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16493 subsequent routers.
16496 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16497 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16498 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16499 .cindex "transport" "local"
16500 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16501 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16502 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16503 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16504 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16505 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16506 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16507 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16508 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16509 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16510 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16511 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16515 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16516 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16517 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16520 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16521 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16523 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16524 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16525 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16526 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16527 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16528 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16530 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16531 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16532 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16536 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16537 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16539 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16540 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16544 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16545 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16546 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16547 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16549 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16550 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16557 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16560 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16561 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16562 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16563 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16564 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16565 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16566 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16567 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16568 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16572 domains = mydomain.example
16574 transport = local_delivery
16576 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16577 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16578 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16579 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16586 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16587 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16589 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16590 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16591 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16592 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16593 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16594 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16596 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16597 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16598 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16599 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16602 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16603 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16604 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16605 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16606 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16607 generic option, the router declines.
16609 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16610 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16611 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16613 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16614 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16615 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16616 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16617 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16618 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16621 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16622 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16623 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16624 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16625 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16626 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16628 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16629 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16630 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16631 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16632 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16633 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16634 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16635 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16636 case routing fails.
16641 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16642 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16643 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16645 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16646 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16647 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16648 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16649 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16650 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16651 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16654 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16655 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16656 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16657 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16658 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16659 required. For example,
16663 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16664 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16665 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16666 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16667 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16670 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16671 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16672 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16673 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16674 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16675 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16677 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16678 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16679 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16680 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16681 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16682 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16683 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16684 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16686 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16687 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16691 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16692 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16693 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16694 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16695 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16696 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16697 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16700 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16702 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16703 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16704 the address record.
16707 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16708 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16709 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16710 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16715 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16716 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16717 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16718 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16719 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16720 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16721 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16722 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16723 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16728 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16729 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16730 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16731 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16732 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16733 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16734 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16735 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16736 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16737 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16738 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16740 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16741 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16744 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16745 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16746 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16747 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16748 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16752 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16753 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16754 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16755 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16756 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16757 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16758 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16759 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16761 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16762 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16763 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16764 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16765 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16766 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16767 without processing them independently,
16768 provided the following conditions are met:
16771 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16772 &%headers_remove%&.
16774 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16781 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16782 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16783 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16784 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16785 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16786 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16787 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16788 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16789 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16790 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16792 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16793 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16798 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16799 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16800 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16801 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16806 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
16807 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
16808 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16809 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16812 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16814 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
16815 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
16816 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
16817 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16818 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
16819 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
16822 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
16823 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16824 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
16825 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
16826 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16828 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16829 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16830 such as that implied by
16834 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16835 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16836 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
16837 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
16847 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16848 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16850 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
16851 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
16852 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
16853 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
16854 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16855 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
16856 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16857 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
16858 router handles the address
16862 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
16863 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
16864 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
16866 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
16868 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
16869 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
16871 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
16872 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
16873 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16874 &%self%& option determines what happens.
16876 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16877 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16878 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
16879 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16883 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16884 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16886 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
16887 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
16888 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
16889 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16890 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16891 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16894 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16896 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
16898 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16899 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16900 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16901 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16902 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16903 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
16904 must not be specified for it.
16906 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
16907 .option hosts iplookup string unset
16908 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16909 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
16910 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
16911 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16912 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
16915 .option optional iplookup boolean false
16916 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
16917 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
16918 delivery to the address is deferred.
16921 .option port iplookup integer 0
16922 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
16923 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16927 .option protocol iplookup string udp
16928 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
16929 protocols is to be used.
16932 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
16933 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16936 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
16938 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
16939 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
16942 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
16943 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16944 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16945 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16946 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
16947 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
16948 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16949 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
16952 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
16953 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16954 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16955 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
16956 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
16957 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
16958 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
16959 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
16960 following could be used:
16962 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
16963 reroute = $local_part@$1
16966 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
16967 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
16968 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
16969 call. It does not apply to UDP.
16974 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16975 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16977 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
16978 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
16979 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
16980 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
16981 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
16982 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
16983 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
16984 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
16985 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
16986 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
16988 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
16989 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
16990 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
16991 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
16992 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
16993 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
16994 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
16997 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
16998 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
16999 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17000 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17001 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17002 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17003 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17006 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17007 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17008 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17009 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17010 below, following the list of private options.
17013 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17015 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17016 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17018 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17019 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17021 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17022 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17023 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17024 of the following values:
17033 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17034 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17035 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17038 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17039 router only if &%more%& is true.
17041 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17042 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17043 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17044 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17046 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17047 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17048 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17051 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17052 .cindex "randomized host list"
17053 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17054 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17055 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17056 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17057 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17058 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17059 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17060 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17062 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17063 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17064 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17065 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17067 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17069 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17070 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17071 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17072 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17073 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17076 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17077 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17078 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17081 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17083 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17084 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17088 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17089 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17090 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17091 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17094 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17095 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17096 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17097 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17098 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17099 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17100 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17101 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17103 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17104 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17105 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17106 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17107 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17108 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17109 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17110 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17115 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17116 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17117 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17118 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17119 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17120 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17122 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17124 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17128 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17129 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17131 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17132 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17133 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17134 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17135 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17136 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17137 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17138 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17139 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17140 in a &%route_list%&).
17142 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17143 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17144 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17145 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17149 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17150 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17151 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17152 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17153 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17154 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17155 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17158 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17159 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17161 This data can be accessed by setting
17163 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17165 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17166 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17167 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17168 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17169 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17174 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17175 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17176 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17177 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17178 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17179 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17180 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17182 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17183 variables are set during its expansion:
17186 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17187 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17188 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17190 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17193 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17195 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17198 .vindex "&$value$&"
17199 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17200 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17202 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17206 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17207 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17211 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17212 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17213 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17214 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17215 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17216 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17219 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17220 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17221 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17223 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17224 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17227 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17228 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17229 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17230 number follows. For example:
17232 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17236 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17237 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17238 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17239 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17240 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17243 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17244 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17245 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17246 records in the DNS. For example:
17248 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17250 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17253 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17255 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17256 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17257 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17258 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17259 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17260 happens is controlled by the
17261 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17262 &%self%& option of the router.
17264 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17265 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17266 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17267 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17268 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17269 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17270 defined by MX preferences.
17272 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17273 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17274 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17276 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17277 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17278 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17279 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17281 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17282 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17285 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17286 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17287 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17289 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17290 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17294 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17295 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17296 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17297 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17298 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17299 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17300 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17303 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17304 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17306 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17307 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17309 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17310 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17311 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17313 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17314 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17315 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17320 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17321 domain2 host4:host5
17323 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17324 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17325 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17326 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17329 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17330 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17331 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17332 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17337 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17338 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17341 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17342 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17346 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17347 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17348 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17351 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17352 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17353 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17354 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17356 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17358 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17359 your first router something like this:
17362 driver = manualroute
17363 domains = !+local_domains
17364 transport = remote_smtp
17365 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17367 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17368 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17369 they are tried in order
17370 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17371 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17374 driver = manualroute
17375 transport = remote_smtp
17376 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17378 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17379 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17380 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17381 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17382 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17383 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17384 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17385 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17388 .cindex "mail hub example"
17389 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17390 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17391 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17392 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17393 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17394 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17395 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17396 lookup is easier to manage.
17398 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17399 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17403 driver = manualroute
17404 transport = remote_smtp
17405 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17407 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17408 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17409 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17410 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17411 domain can be used to find the host:
17414 driver = manualroute
17415 transport = remote_smtp
17416 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17418 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17419 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17420 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17424 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17425 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17426 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17427 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17428 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17429 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17432 driver = manualroute
17433 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17434 route_list = saved.domain.example
17436 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17437 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17438 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17441 driver = manualroute
17443 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17444 *.saved.domain2.example \
17445 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17448 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17450 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17451 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17452 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17453 the address if the lookup fails.
17456 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17457 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17458 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17459 one way it can be done:
17465 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17466 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17467 return_fail_output = true
17472 driver = manualroute
17474 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17476 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17478 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17480 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17481 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17482 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17484 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17485 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17494 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17495 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17497 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17498 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17499 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17500 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17501 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17502 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17503 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17504 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17505 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17506 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17508 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17510 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17511 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17512 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17513 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17514 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17517 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17518 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17519 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17520 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17521 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17522 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17525 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17526 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17527 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17528 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17529 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17530 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17531 not set, a value for the gid also.
17533 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17534 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17535 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17536 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17537 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17538 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17542 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17543 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17544 before running the command.
17547 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17548 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17549 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17553 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17554 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17555 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17556 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17557 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17560 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17563 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17564 &%no_more%& is set.
17566 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17567 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17568 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17569 included in the SMTP response.
17571 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17572 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17573 included in any SMTP response.
17575 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17577 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17578 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17580 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17581 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17582 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17585 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17586 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17589 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17590 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17592 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17593 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17594 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17595 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17597 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17598 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17599 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17600 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17601 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17603 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17604 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17605 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17606 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17607 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17609 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17610 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17611 variable. For example, this return line
17613 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17615 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17616 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17617 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17618 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17623 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17626 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17627 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17628 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17629 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17630 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17631 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17632 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17633 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17634 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17635 redirected in several different ways:
17638 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17641 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17643 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17645 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17647 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17649 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17651 It can be discarded.
17654 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17655 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17656 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17657 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17661 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17662 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17663 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17664 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17665 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17666 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17670 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17672 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17673 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17674 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17675 cause delivery to be deferred.
17677 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17678 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17683 file = $home/.forward
17686 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17687 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17688 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17689 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17694 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17695 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17696 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17697 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17700 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17701 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17702 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17703 practice the router may not be able to operate.
17705 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17706 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17707 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17708 saves some resources.
17716 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17717 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17718 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17719 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17720 can be interpreted in two different ways:
17723 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17724 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17725 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17726 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17727 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17728 document is intended for use by end users.
17730 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17731 described in the next section.
17734 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17735 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17736 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17737 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17738 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17742 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17743 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17744 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17745 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17746 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17747 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17748 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17749 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17750 commas or newlines.
17751 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17754 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17755 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17756 next newline character is ignored.
17758 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17759 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17760 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17761 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17764 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17765 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17766 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17767 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17768 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17769 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17772 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17776 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17777 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
17778 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17779 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17780 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17781 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17782 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17783 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17784 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17785 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17786 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17788 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17789 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17790 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17791 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17792 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17794 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17796 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
17797 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
17798 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17799 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17800 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17803 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
17804 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
17805 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
17806 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
17807 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
17809 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17810 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17815 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
17816 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17819 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17821 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
17822 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
17823 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17824 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17825 should really contain
17827 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17829 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
17830 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17831 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
17835 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
17836 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17837 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17840 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
17841 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
17842 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
17843 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17844 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
17845 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17846 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17848 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17849 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17850 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17851 in double quotes, for example:
17853 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17855 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17856 quote just the command. An item such as
17858 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17860 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17863 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
17864 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
17865 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
17866 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17868 /home/world/minbari
17870 is treated as a file name, but
17872 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17874 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17875 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17876 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17877 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
17879 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17880 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17882 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
17883 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
17884 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
17885 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17888 .cindex "included address list"
17889 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
17890 If an item is of the form
17892 :include:<path name>
17894 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17895 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
17896 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
17897 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
17898 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
17899 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
17901 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17903 It must be given as
17905 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17908 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
17909 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17910 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
17911 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17912 .cindex "black hole"
17913 .cindex "abandoning mail"
17914 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
17915 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
17916 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
17918 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17919 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17920 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17921 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17925 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
17926 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
17927 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
17928 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
17929 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
17930 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17931 redirection items of the form
17936 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
17937 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
17938 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
17939 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17941 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17943 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17945 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
17946 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17948 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
17949 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
17950 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17952 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
17953 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
17954 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
17955 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
17956 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
17957 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
17958 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
17959 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
17960 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
17963 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
17964 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
17965 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
17966 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
17968 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
17969 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
17970 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
17971 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
17972 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
17974 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
17975 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
17976 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
17977 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
17978 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
17982 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
17983 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
17984 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
17985 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
17986 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
17987 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
17988 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
17992 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
17993 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17994 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
17995 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
17996 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
17997 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
17998 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
17999 aliasing scheme of the type
18001 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18005 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18006 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18007 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18010 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18011 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18013 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18014 the pipes are distinct.
18018 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18019 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18020 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18021 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18022 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18023 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18024 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18025 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18026 can be used to avoid this.
18029 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18030 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18031 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18032 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18033 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18034 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18035 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18039 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18041 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18042 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18045 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18046 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18047 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18050 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18051 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18052 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18053 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18056 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18057 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18058 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18059 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18060 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18061 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18062 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18064 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18065 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18068 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18069 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18070 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18071 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18072 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18076 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18077 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18078 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18079 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18080 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18081 let ordinary users do.
18085 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18086 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18087 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18088 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18089 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18090 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18092 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18093 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18094 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18095 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18096 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18097 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18099 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18101 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18102 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18103 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18104 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18105 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18106 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18107 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18108 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18111 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18112 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18113 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18114 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18115 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18116 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18117 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18118 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18122 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18123 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18124 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18125 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18126 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18127 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18130 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18131 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18132 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18133 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18134 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18135 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18137 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18138 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18139 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18141 data = #Exim filter\n\
18142 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18144 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18145 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18146 choice into a newline.
18149 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18150 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18151 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18152 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18153 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18156 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18157 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18158 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18159 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18160 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18161 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18162 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18163 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18165 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18166 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18167 runs a check on the containing directory,
18168 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18169 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18170 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18171 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18172 not, the router declines.
18175 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18176 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18177 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18178 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18179 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18180 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18181 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18184 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18185 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18186 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18187 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18188 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18191 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18192 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18196 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18197 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18198 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18203 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18204 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18205 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18206 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18207 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18208 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18209 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18210 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18211 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18214 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18215 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18216 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18217 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18220 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18221 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18222 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18223 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18225 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18226 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18227 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18228 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18229 &_.forward_& files).
18232 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18233 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18234 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18237 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18238 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18239 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18240 of the embedded Perl support.
18243 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18244 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18245 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18248 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18249 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18250 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18253 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18254 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18255 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18256 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18257 &%one_time%& is set.
18260 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18261 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18262 to make use of &%run%& items.
18265 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18266 If this option is true, items of the form
18268 :include:<path name>
18270 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18273 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18274 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18275 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18276 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18277 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18280 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18281 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18282 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18285 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18286 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18287 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18288 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18289 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18294 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18295 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18296 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18297 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18298 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18299 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18300 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18303 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18305 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18306 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18307 file did not exist.
18310 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18312 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18313 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18314 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18316 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18317 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18318 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18319 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18320 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18321 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18322 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18323 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18327 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18328 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18329 redirection list must start with this directory.
18332 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18333 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18334 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18337 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18338 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18339 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18340 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18341 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18342 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18343 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18344 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18345 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18346 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18347 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18348 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18349 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18350 before they subscribed.
18352 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18353 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18354 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18355 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18358 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18359 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18360 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18361 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18363 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18364 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18365 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18367 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18370 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18371 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18372 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18373 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18374 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18378 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18379 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18380 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18381 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18382 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18383 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18384 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18385 See &%check_owner%& above.
18388 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18389 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18390 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18391 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18394 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18395 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18396 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18397 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18398 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18399 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18400 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18403 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18404 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18405 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18406 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18407 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18408 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18409 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18410 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18412 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18413 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18414 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18417 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18418 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18419 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18420 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18421 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18422 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18423 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18424 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18425 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18426 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18429 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18430 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18431 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18432 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18433 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18434 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18437 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18438 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18439 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18440 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18441 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18442 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18445 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18446 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18447 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18448 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18449 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18452 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18453 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18454 :subaddress part of an address.
18456 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18457 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18458 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18459 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18462 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18463 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18464 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18465 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18466 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18467 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18468 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18472 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18473 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18474 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18475 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18476 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18477 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18478 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18479 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18480 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18481 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18482 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18483 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18484 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18485 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18486 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18487 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18489 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18490 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18491 the following routers.
18493 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18494 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18495 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18496 so it is passed to the following routers.
18498 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18499 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18500 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18501 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18503 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18504 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18505 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18506 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18512 file = $home/.forward
18513 file_transport = address_file
18514 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18515 reply_transport = address_reply
18518 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18519 syntax_errors_text = \
18520 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18521 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18522 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18523 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18524 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18525 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18526 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18527 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18528 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18529 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18531 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18532 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18533 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18538 local_part_prefix = real-
18539 transport = local_delivery
18541 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18542 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18544 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18545 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18549 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18550 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18553 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18554 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18555 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18556 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18564 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18566 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18567 "Environment for local transports"
18568 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18569 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18570 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18571 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18572 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18573 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18574 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18576 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18577 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18578 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18579 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18581 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18582 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18583 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18584 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18585 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18589 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18590 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18591 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18592 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18593 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18594 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18595 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18598 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18599 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18603 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18605 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18606 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18607 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18608 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18613 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18614 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18615 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18616 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18617 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18618 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18619 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18620 group (set by the transport). For example:
18623 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18627 transport = group_delivery
18630 # This transport overrides the group
18632 driver = appendfile
18633 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18636 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18637 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18638 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18641 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18642 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18643 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18644 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18645 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18646 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18648 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18649 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18650 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18651 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18652 original gid is also used.
18654 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18655 following that is set is used:
18658 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18660 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18662 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18663 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18665 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18667 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18668 the uid is the creator's uid;
18670 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18673 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18674 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18675 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18676 The first of the following that is set is used:
18679 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18681 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18683 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18685 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18690 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18691 &%never_users%& list.
18697 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18698 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18699 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18700 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18701 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18702 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18703 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18704 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18705 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18706 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18709 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18711 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18713 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18715 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18718 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18721 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18723 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18727 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18728 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18729 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18733 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18734 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18735 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18736 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18737 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18738 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18739 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18740 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18741 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18742 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18743 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18744 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18745 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18746 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18754 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18757 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18758 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18759 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18760 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18761 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18764 .option body_only transports boolean false
18765 .cindex "transport" "body only"
18766 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18767 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18768 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18769 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18770 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18771 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18772 automatically suppress them.
18775 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18776 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18777 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18778 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18779 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18780 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18783 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
18784 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18785 deliveries by the transport or for any
18786 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18787 what you are doing.
18790 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18791 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18792 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18793 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18795 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18796 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18797 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18798 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
18799 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
18800 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18804 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
18805 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
18806 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
18807 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
18808 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
18809 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
18810 safely be resent to other recipients.
18813 .option driver transports string unset
18814 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18815 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18818 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
18819 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
18820 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
18821 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18822 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18823 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18824 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18825 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
18826 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18827 resent to other recipients.
18830 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
18831 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
18832 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18833 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18834 &%user%& (see below).
18837 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
18838 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
18839 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
18840 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18841 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18842 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
18843 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18844 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18845 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18849 .option headers_only transports boolean false
18850 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
18851 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
18852 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
18853 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18854 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
18855 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
18856 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18859 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
18860 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18861 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
18862 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18863 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18864 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
18865 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18866 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18867 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18871 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
18872 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
18873 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
18874 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18875 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18876 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18877 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18878 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
18881 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18884 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
18885 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
18886 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
18887 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
18888 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
18889 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
18890 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
18891 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
18892 change envelope recipients at this time.
18895 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
18896 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
18898 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
18899 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
18900 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
18901 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18902 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
18903 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
18904 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
18908 .option initgroups transports boolean false
18909 .cindex "additional groups"
18910 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18911 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
18912 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18913 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
18914 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18917 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
18918 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
18919 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
18920 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
18921 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18922 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
18923 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
18924 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
18925 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
18926 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
18927 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
18928 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
18929 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
18934 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
18935 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
18936 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
18937 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
18938 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
18939 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18940 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18941 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18944 local_part_prefix = *-
18946 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18949 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18951 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
18952 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
18953 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
18954 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
18955 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
18958 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
18959 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18960 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
18961 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
18962 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
18963 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
18964 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
18965 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
18966 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
18968 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
18969 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
18970 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
18971 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
18973 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
18974 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
18975 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
18978 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
18979 .cindex "envelope sender"
18980 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
18981 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
18982 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
18983 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
18984 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
18985 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
18986 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
18987 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
18988 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
18990 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
18991 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
18993 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
18994 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
18995 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
18996 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
18997 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
18998 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
18999 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19001 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19002 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19003 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19004 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19005 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19009 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19010 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19011 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19012 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19013 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19014 have easy access to it.
19016 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19017 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19018 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19019 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19020 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19024 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19025 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19028 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19029 .cindex "shadow transport"
19030 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19031 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19032 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19034 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19035 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19036 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19037 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19038 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19039 cause a log line to be written.
19041 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19042 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19043 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19044 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19045 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19048 ST=<shadow transport name>
19050 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19051 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19052 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19053 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19054 headers that some sites insist on.
19057 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19058 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19059 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19060 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19061 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19062 individual users or via a system filter.
19064 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19065 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19066 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19067 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19068 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19070 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19071 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19072 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19073 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19074 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19075 &(pipe)& transports.
19077 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19078 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19079 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19080 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19081 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19083 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19084 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19085 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19086 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19088 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19089 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19090 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19091 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19092 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19093 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19095 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19096 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19097 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19098 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19099 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19100 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19101 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19102 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19104 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19105 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19106 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19107 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19108 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19109 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19110 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19111 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19112 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19113 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19116 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19117 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19118 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19119 which the message is being sent. For example:
19121 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19122 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19125 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19126 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19127 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19129 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19130 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19131 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19134 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19136 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19137 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19138 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19139 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19140 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19141 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19143 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19144 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19145 arguments. Consider this example:
19147 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19148 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19150 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19151 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19153 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19154 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19158 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19159 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19160 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19161 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19162 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19163 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19164 bounced from a transport filter.
19166 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19167 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19168 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19171 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19172 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19173 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19174 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19175 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19176 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19177 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19178 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19179 becomes a temporary error.
19182 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19183 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19184 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19185 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19186 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19187 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19188 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19191 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19192 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19193 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19195 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19196 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19197 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19198 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19200 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19201 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19202 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19209 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19210 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19212 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19214 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19215 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19216 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19217 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19218 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19219 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19220 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19222 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19223 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19224 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19225 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19226 local transport, for example:
19229 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19230 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19231 recipients saves space.
19233 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19234 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19236 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19237 to a scanner program or
19238 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19242 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19243 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19244 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19246 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19247 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19248 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19249 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19250 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19251 to certain conditions:
19254 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19255 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19256 batching is possible.
19258 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19259 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19260 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19262 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19263 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19264 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19265 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19266 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19269 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19270 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19271 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19275 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19276 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19277 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19278 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19279 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19280 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19281 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19284 escape_string = ".."
19286 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19287 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19288 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19290 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19291 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19292 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19293 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19294 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19295 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19297 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19298 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19299 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19300 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19301 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19302 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19303 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19304 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19305 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19310 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19311 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19313 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19314 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19315 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19316 .cindex "directory creation"
19317 .cindex "creating directories"
19318 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19319 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19320 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19321 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19322 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19323 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19324 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19325 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19326 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19327 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19329 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19330 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19331 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19334 .cindex "quota" "system"
19335 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19336 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19337 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19339 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19340 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19341 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19342 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19344 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19345 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19348 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19349 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19350 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19351 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19356 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19357 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19358 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19359 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19360 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19362 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19363 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19364 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19365 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19366 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19367 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19368 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19369 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19370 operation. There are two cases:
19373 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19374 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19375 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19376 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19377 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19378 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19379 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19381 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19382 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19383 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19387 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19388 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19389 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19390 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19395 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19397 require "fileinto";
19398 fileinto "folder23";
19400 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19401 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19402 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19403 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19404 way of handling this requirement:
19406 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19407 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19408 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19410 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19414 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19415 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19416 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19418 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19419 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19420 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19421 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19422 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19423 path to the transport.
19425 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19426 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19431 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19432 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19436 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19437 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19438 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19439 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19440 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19441 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19442 delivery is deferred.
19445 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19446 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19447 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19448 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19449 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19450 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19451 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19452 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19455 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19456 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19457 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19458 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19462 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19463 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19466 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19467 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19468 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19469 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19470 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19473 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19474 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19475 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19476 process is running.
19479 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19480 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19481 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19482 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19483 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19484 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19485 contains is significant.
19487 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19488 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19489 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19490 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19491 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19493 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19494 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19495 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19496 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19497 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19498 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19500 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19501 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19502 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19503 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19505 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19506 .cindex "directory creation"
19507 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19508 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19509 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19511 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19512 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19513 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19514 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19515 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19519 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19520 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19521 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19522 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19523 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19526 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19527 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19528 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19529 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19530 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19531 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19532 &%file_must_exist%&.
19535 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19536 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19537 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19538 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19540 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19541 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19542 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19543 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19544 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19547 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19549 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19550 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19551 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19552 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19554 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19556 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19557 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19561 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19562 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19563 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19566 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19567 See &%check_string%& above.
19570 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19571 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19572 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19573 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19574 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19575 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19578 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19579 .cindex "locking files"
19580 .cindex "lock files"
19581 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19582 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19584 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19585 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19588 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19589 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19592 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19593 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19594 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19595 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19596 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19597 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19601 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19602 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19603 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19604 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19605 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19606 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19607 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19608 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19609 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19612 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19613 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19615 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19616 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19617 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19618 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19619 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19620 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19621 delivery is deferred.
19624 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19625 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19626 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19627 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19630 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19631 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19632 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19633 .cindex "locking files"
19634 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19635 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19636 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19637 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19638 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19639 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19640 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19641 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19643 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19644 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19645 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19646 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19648 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19649 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19652 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19654 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19655 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19656 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19658 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19659 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19661 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19664 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19665 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19666 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19667 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19670 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19671 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19672 for details of locking.
19675 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19676 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19677 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19680 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19681 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19682 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19685 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19686 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19687 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19688 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19689 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19692 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19693 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19694 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19695 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19696 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19697 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19698 external source that maintains the data.
19701 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19702 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19703 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19704 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19705 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19706 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19707 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19708 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19712 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19713 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19714 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19715 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19716 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19717 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19718 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19719 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19720 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19721 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19724 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19725 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19726 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19727 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19728 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19729 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19730 calculation. The default value is:
19732 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19734 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19735 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19737 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19739 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19741 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19742 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19743 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19744 directly into that directory.
19747 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19748 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19749 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19752 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19753 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19754 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19757 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile boolean false
19758 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19759 Setting this option true enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19760 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19761 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19762 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19763 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19765 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19766 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19767 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19768 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19769 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19770 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19771 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19772 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19773 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19774 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19777 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19778 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19779 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19780 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19781 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19782 below for further details.
19785 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19786 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19787 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19790 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19791 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19792 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19795 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
19796 .cindex "locking files"
19797 .cindex "file" "locking"
19798 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
19799 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
19800 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19801 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
19802 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19803 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19804 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
19806 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
19807 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
19808 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19815 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19816 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19817 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
19818 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19819 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19820 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19821 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19822 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19824 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19825 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
19826 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19827 append messages to it.
19830 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19831 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19832 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19833 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19834 in which case it is:
19836 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19837 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19839 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19840 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
19842 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19843 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19844 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19845 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19850 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19851 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
19853 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19854 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19855 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19856 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
19857 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
19858 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19859 value, and this option is ignored.
19862 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
19863 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19864 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
19865 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
19866 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19869 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
19870 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
19871 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
19872 on users about incoming mail.
19875 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
19876 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
19877 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19878 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
19879 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19880 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19881 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
19882 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
19883 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19885 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19886 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19887 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19889 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
19890 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19891 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19892 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19893 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
19894 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19896 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19897 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
19898 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
19899 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
19902 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
19904 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
19905 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
19906 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19907 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19908 system quota failures.
19910 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19911 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19912 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19913 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19914 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19915 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19916 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
19917 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19918 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19919 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
19922 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
19923 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19924 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19925 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19926 delivery directory.
19929 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
19930 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
19931 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19932 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19933 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
19937 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
19938 See &%quota%& above.
19941 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
19942 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19943 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19944 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
19945 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19946 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19947 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
19949 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19950 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19951 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
19952 the file length to the file name. For example:
19954 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19955 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
19957 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
19958 number of lines in the message.
19960 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
19961 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
19962 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
19966 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
19967 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
19968 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
19970 quota_warn_message = "\
19971 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
19972 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
19973 This message is automatically created \
19974 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
19975 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
19976 a warning threshold that is\n\
19977 set by the system administrator.\n"
19981 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
19982 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
19983 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
19984 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19985 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
19986 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
19987 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
19988 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
19989 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
19993 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
19995 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
19996 percent sign is ignored.
19998 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
19999 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20000 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20001 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20002 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20003 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20005 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20007 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20008 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20011 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20012 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20016 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20017 .cindex "envelope sender"
20018 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20019 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20020 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20021 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20022 for details of batch SMTP.
20025 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20026 .cindex "carriage return"
20028 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20029 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20030 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20031 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20033 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20034 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20035 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20036 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20037 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20038 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20041 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20042 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20043 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20044 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20045 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20046 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20049 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20050 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20051 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20052 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20053 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20055 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20056 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20057 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20058 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20060 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20061 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20062 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20063 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20064 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20067 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20068 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20071 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20072 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20073 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20074 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20075 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20076 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20077 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20079 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20080 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20081 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20082 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20085 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20086 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20087 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20090 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20091 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20092 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20093 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20094 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20095 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20096 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20097 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20098 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20100 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20101 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20102 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20103 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20108 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20109 .cindex "appending to a file"
20110 .cindex "file" "appending"
20111 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20114 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20118 .cindex "directory creation"
20119 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20120 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20121 &%directory_mode%& option.
20124 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20125 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20129 .cindex "file" "locking"
20130 .cindex "locking files"
20131 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20132 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20133 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20136 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20137 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20138 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20140 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20142 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20143 Unlink the hitching post name.
20145 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20146 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20147 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20148 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20150 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20151 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20152 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20153 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20154 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20155 it before trying again.
20159 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20160 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20161 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20164 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20165 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20166 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20167 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20168 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20169 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20170 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20171 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20172 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20176 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20177 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20178 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20179 delivery is deferred.
20182 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20183 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20184 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20188 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20189 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20190 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20193 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20194 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20195 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20198 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20199 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20200 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20201 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20202 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20203 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20204 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20205 that prevents link following.
20208 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20209 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20210 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20211 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20212 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20215 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20218 .cindex "file" "locking"
20219 .cindex "locking files"
20220 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20221 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20222 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20223 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20224 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20226 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20228 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20229 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20230 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20232 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20233 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20234 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20236 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20237 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20238 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20239 delivery is deferred.
20241 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20242 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20243 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20244 immediately. It retries up to
20246 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20248 times (rounded up).
20251 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20252 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20255 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20256 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20257 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20258 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20259 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20260 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20261 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20262 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20263 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20264 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20266 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20267 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20268 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20269 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20270 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20271 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20272 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20274 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20275 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20276 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20277 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20280 .cindex "maildir format"
20281 .cindex "mailstore format"
20282 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20283 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20284 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20285 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20286 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20288 .cindex "directory creation"
20289 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20290 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20291 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20292 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20293 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20294 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20299 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20300 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20301 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20302 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20303 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20304 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20305 &_new_& subdirectory.
20307 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20308 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20309 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20310 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20311 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20312 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20313 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20315 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20316 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20317 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20318 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20319 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20320 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20321 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20322 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20324 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20325 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20326 folders. Consider this example:
20328 maildir_format = true
20329 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20330 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20331 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20332 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20334 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20335 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20336 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20337 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20338 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20339 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20341 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20342 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20343 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20344 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20345 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20347 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20348 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20349 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20351 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20352 .cindex "maildir++"
20353 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20354 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20355 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20356 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20357 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20358 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20359 amount of space used.
20361 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20362 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20363 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20364 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20365 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20366 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20371 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20372 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20373 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20374 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20375 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20376 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20378 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20379 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20380 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20381 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20382 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20383 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20384 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20385 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20386 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20391 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20392 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20393 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20394 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20395 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20396 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20397 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20398 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20399 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20401 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20402 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20403 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20404 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20405 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20406 need to know the quota.
20408 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20409 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20411 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20412 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20413 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20417 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20418 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20419 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20420 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20421 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20422 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20423 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20424 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20426 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20427 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20428 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20429 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20430 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20431 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20433 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20434 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20435 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20436 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20437 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20438 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20440 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20441 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20442 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20443 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20446 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20447 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20448 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20449 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20450 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20452 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20454 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20455 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20456 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20457 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20458 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20465 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20466 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20468 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20469 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20470 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20471 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20472 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20473 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20474 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20475 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20477 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20478 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20479 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20480 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20481 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20484 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20485 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20486 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20487 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20488 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20490 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20491 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20492 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20493 transport is run as a consequence of a
20495 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20496 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20497 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20498 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20499 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20500 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20502 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20503 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20504 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20505 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20507 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20508 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20509 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20510 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20511 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20512 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20513 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20515 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20516 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20517 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20518 the transport defers.
20519 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20520 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20522 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20523 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20524 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20525 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20527 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20528 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20529 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20530 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20531 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20532 problems. They are just discarded.
20536 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20537 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20539 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20540 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20541 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20544 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20545 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20546 when the message is specified by the transport.
20549 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20550 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20551 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20552 string comes first.
20555 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20556 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20557 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20560 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20561 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20562 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20565 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20566 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20567 specified by the transport.
20570 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20571 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20572 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20573 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20576 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20577 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20578 the message is specified by the transport.
20581 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20582 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20586 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20587 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20588 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20589 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20590 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20594 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20595 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20596 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20597 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20599 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20600 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20601 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20602 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20603 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20604 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20605 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20608 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20609 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20610 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20611 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20612 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20614 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20615 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20616 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20617 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20618 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20619 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20622 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20623 See &%once%& above.
20626 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20627 See &%once%& above.
20628 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20631 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20632 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20633 specified by the transport.
20636 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20637 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20638 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20639 configuration option.
20642 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20643 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20644 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20645 automatic responses. For example:
20647 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20649 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20650 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20651 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20652 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20657 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20658 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20659 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20660 the text comes first.
20663 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20664 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20665 when the message is specified by the transport.
20666 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20667 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20673 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20675 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20676 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20677 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20678 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20679 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20680 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20682 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20683 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20684 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20685 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20686 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20687 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20691 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20692 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20693 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20696 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20697 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20700 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20701 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20702 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20703 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20704 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20707 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
20708 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20709 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20710 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20711 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20712 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20715 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20716 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20717 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20718 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20719 in its response to the LHLO command.
20721 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20722 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20723 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20724 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20727 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
20728 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20729 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
20730 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
20735 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20739 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20740 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20745 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20747 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20748 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20749 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20750 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20751 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20752 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20753 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20754 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20758 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20759 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20760 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20761 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20762 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20764 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20765 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20766 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20767 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20768 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20769 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20770 that are routed to the transport.
20772 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20773 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20774 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20775 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20776 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20777 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20778 the local part that was redirected.
20782 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20783 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20784 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
20786 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20787 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20788 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20789 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
20790 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
20791 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
20792 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
20795 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
20796 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20797 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20798 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20799 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
20804 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
20805 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
20806 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20807 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
20808 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20809 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
20810 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20811 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20812 &"local delivery failed"&.
20814 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20815 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20816 value is the return code minus 128.
20818 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
20819 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20820 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20821 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20823 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20824 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20825 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20826 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
20827 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
20828 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20829 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20834 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
20835 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
20836 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20837 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
20838 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
20841 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
20842 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20843 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20844 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20846 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20847 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20848 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20849 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20850 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20852 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
20854 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20855 arguments. You have to write
20857 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
20859 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20860 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20861 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20862 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
20863 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
20864 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
20867 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
20870 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20871 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20872 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20873 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20874 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20875 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20876 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20877 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
20878 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20879 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20881 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20882 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
20883 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20884 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20885 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
20886 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
20887 control what is done with it.
20889 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20890 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20891 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20892 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20893 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
20894 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20895 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
20896 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20897 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
20898 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
20899 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20903 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
20904 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20905 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
20906 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20907 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20908 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
20911 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
20912 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
20913 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
20914 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
20915 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
20916 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
20917 &`LOGNAME `& see below
20918 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
20919 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
20920 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
20921 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
20922 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20923 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
20924 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
20925 &`USER `& see below
20927 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
20928 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20929 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20930 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20931 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20932 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20933 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20936 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
20937 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
20938 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20942 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
20943 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20944 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
20945 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
20948 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
20949 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
20953 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
20954 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
20955 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20956 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
20957 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
20958 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
20959 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
20960 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
20961 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
20962 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
20963 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
20966 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
20968 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
20969 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
20970 &%use_shell%& is set.
20973 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
20974 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20977 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
20978 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20979 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20982 .option check_string pipe string unset
20983 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
20984 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
20985 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
20986 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
20987 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
20988 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
20989 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
20993 .option command pipe string&!! unset
20994 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
20995 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
20996 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
20997 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
20998 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
20999 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21002 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21003 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21004 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21005 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21006 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21007 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21008 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21011 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21012 See &%check_string%& above.
21015 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21016 .cindex "exec failure"
21017 .cindex "failure of exec"
21018 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21019 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21020 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21021 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21022 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21025 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21026 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21027 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21028 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21029 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21030 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21032 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21033 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21035 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21036 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21037 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21038 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21039 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21042 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21043 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21044 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21045 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21046 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21047 Only one of them may be set.
21051 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21052 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21053 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21054 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21058 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21059 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21060 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21061 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21062 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21063 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21064 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21065 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21068 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21069 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21070 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21073 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21077 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21078 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21079 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21080 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21081 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21086 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21087 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21090 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21091 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21092 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21093 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21097 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21098 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21101 .option path pipe string "see below"
21102 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21103 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21107 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21108 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21109 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21112 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21113 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21114 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21115 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21116 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21117 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21118 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21119 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21120 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21123 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21124 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21125 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21126 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21127 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21128 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21129 accept the message is used.
21132 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21133 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21134 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21135 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21136 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21137 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21140 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21141 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21142 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21143 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21144 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21145 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21146 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21150 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21151 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21152 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21153 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21154 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21155 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21156 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21157 of them may be set.
21161 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21162 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21163 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21164 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21165 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21166 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21167 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21168 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21169 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21170 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21171 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21172 and 73, respectively.
21175 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21176 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21177 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21178 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21179 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21180 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21181 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21183 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21184 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21185 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21186 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21187 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21188 delivery to be deferred.
21190 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21191 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21194 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21195 .cindex "envelope sender"
21196 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21197 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21198 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21199 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21200 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21202 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21203 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21204 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21205 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21206 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21207 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21211 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21212 .cindex "carriage return"
21214 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21215 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21216 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21217 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21219 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21220 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21221 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21222 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21223 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21226 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21227 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21228 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21229 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21230 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21231 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21232 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21233 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21234 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21239 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21240 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21241 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21242 .cindex "external local delivery"
21243 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21244 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21245 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21246 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21247 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21248 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21249 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21250 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21251 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21252 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21257 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21261 check_string = "From "
21262 escape_string = ">From "
21271 transport = procmail_pipe
21273 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21274 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21275 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21276 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21277 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21278 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21280 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21284 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21285 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21288 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21289 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21292 local_delivery_cyrus:
21294 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21295 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21307 local_part_suffix = .*
21308 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21310 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21311 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21313 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21314 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21317 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21318 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21320 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21321 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21322 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21323 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21324 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21325 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21326 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21327 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21330 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21331 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21335 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21336 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21337 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21338 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21339 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21340 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21341 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21343 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21344 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21345 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21346 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21347 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21348 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21353 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21354 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21355 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21359 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21361 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21362 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21363 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21364 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21365 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21366 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21367 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21368 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21371 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21372 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21373 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21374 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21375 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21376 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21377 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21378 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21379 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21380 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21381 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21384 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21385 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21386 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21389 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21390 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21391 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21392 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21393 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21394 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21395 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21396 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21398 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21399 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21400 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21401 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21402 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21403 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21404 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21405 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21406 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21409 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21411 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21412 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21413 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21414 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21415 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21418 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21419 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21420 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21421 particular connection.
21423 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21424 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21425 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21426 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21428 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21429 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21430 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21432 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21434 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21435 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21437 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21438 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21442 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21443 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21444 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21445 authenticated as a client.
21448 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21449 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21450 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21451 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21454 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21455 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21456 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21457 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21458 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21459 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21460 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21463 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21464 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21465 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21466 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21467 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21468 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21469 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21473 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21474 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21475 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21476 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21479 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21480 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21481 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21484 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21485 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21486 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21487 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21488 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21489 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21491 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21492 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21493 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21494 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21495 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21496 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21497 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21498 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21502 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21503 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21504 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21505 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21506 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21509 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21510 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21511 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21512 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21517 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21518 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21519 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21520 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21521 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21522 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21523 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21524 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21526 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21527 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21528 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21529 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21530 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21531 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21533 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21534 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21535 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21536 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21537 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21539 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21540 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21541 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21542 copy of the message is sent.
21544 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21545 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21546 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21547 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21551 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21552 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21553 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21556 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21557 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21558 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21559 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21560 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21561 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21563 .option gnutls_require_kx smtp string unset
21564 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21565 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21567 .option gnutls_require_mac smtp string unset
21568 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21569 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21571 .option gnutls_require_protocols smtp string unset
21572 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21573 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21575 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
21576 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
21577 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
21578 implementations of TLS.
21580 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21581 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21582 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21583 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21584 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21585 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21586 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21591 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21592 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21593 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21594 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21595 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21596 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21597 interface address, you could use this:
21599 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21600 {$primary_hostname}}
21602 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21605 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21606 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21607 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21608 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21609 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21610 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21612 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21613 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21614 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21615 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21617 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21618 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21619 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21620 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21621 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21622 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21623 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21625 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21626 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21627 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21628 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21629 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21630 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21631 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21634 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21635 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21638 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21639 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21640 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21641 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21642 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21643 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21644 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21645 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21646 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21647 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21650 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21651 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21652 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21653 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21656 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21657 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21658 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21659 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21662 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21663 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21664 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21665 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21666 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21667 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21668 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21669 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21672 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21673 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21674 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21679 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21680 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21681 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21682 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21683 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21684 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21685 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21686 explanation of when this might be needed.
21689 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21690 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21691 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21692 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21693 &%fallback_hosts%&.
21696 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21697 .cindex "randomized host list"
21698 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21699 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21700 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21701 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21702 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21703 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21704 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21705 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21707 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21708 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21709 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21710 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21712 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21714 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21715 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21716 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21718 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21719 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21720 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21721 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21722 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21723 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21724 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21725 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21726 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21729 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21730 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21731 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21732 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21733 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21734 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21736 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21737 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21738 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21739 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21740 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21741 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21742 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21744 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21745 .cindex "bind IP address"
21746 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
21748 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21749 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21750 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21751 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21752 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21753 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21754 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21755 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21758 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21759 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21760 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21761 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21762 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21763 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21765 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21767 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21768 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21769 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21770 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21773 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
21774 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
21775 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21776 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21777 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
21778 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
21779 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
21780 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
21781 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
21782 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21786 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
21787 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21788 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
21789 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
21790 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
21792 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
21793 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
21794 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21795 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21796 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
21800 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
21801 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21802 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
21803 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
21804 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
21805 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
21806 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
21807 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
21810 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
21811 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
21812 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
21813 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
21814 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
21815 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
21816 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
21817 variable that contains an outgoing port.
21819 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
21820 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
21821 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
21822 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
21827 .option protocol smtp string smtp
21828 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
21829 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
21830 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
21831 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21832 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21833 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
21836 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
21837 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21838 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21839 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21840 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21841 addresses is not affected.
21843 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21844 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21845 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21846 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21847 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
21851 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
21852 .cindex "serializing connections"
21853 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
21854 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21855 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21856 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21857 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21858 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21859 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
21861 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
21862 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21863 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21864 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21865 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21866 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21868 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21869 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21870 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21871 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21872 are used for ETRN serialization.
21875 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
21876 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21877 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
21878 .cindex "size" "of message"
21879 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21880 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21881 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21882 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21883 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
21884 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21885 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21886 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21888 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
21889 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21892 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
21893 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
21894 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
21896 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21897 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21898 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
21899 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
21900 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
21903 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
21904 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
21905 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
21906 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
21910 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
21911 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
21912 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
21913 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21914 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21917 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
21918 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
21920 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21921 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21922 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
21923 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
21924 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21925 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
21926 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21927 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21930 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
21931 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
21932 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
21934 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21935 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21936 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21937 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
21938 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21939 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
21940 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
21941 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
21942 ciphers is a preference order.
21946 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
21947 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
21948 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
21949 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21950 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21951 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21952 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
21953 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21954 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21955 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21959 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
21960 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
21961 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
21963 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21964 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
21965 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
21966 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
21967 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
21968 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
21969 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
21970 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21971 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21976 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
21978 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21979 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
21980 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
21981 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
21982 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
21985 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
21986 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
21987 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
21988 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
21991 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
21992 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
21993 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
21995 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
21996 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
21997 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
21998 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
21999 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22001 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22002 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22003 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22004 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22005 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22006 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22007 see below for an exception).
22009 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22010 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22011 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22012 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22013 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22015 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22016 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22017 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22018 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22019 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22020 reached their retry times.
22022 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22023 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22024 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22025 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22026 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22027 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22028 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22029 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22030 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22031 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22034 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22035 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22036 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22037 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22038 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22039 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22041 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22042 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22043 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22044 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22045 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22046 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22053 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22055 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22056 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22057 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22058 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22059 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22060 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22062 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22063 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22064 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22065 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22066 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22067 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22068 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22070 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22071 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22072 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22073 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22076 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22077 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22078 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22079 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22081 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22082 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22083 facility; you do not have to use it.
22085 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22086 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22087 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22088 address to which it applies.
22090 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22091 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22092 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22093 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22094 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22095 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22098 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22099 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22100 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22101 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22104 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22105 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22106 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22107 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22108 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22111 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22112 illustrated by these examples:
22115 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22116 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22117 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22118 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22120 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22121 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22126 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22127 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22128 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22129 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22130 message's processing.
22132 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22133 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22134 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22135 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22136 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22137 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22138 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22139 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22140 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22142 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22143 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22144 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22145 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22146 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22147 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22148 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22149 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22150 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22151 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22153 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22154 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22155 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22156 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22157 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22158 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22160 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22161 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22162 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22164 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22165 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22166 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22167 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22168 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22169 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22170 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22171 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22172 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22174 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22175 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22181 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22182 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22183 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22184 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22185 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22186 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22187 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22188 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22189 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22190 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22192 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22194 might produce the output
22196 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22197 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22198 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22199 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22200 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22201 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22202 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22203 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22205 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22206 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22207 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22208 set for a particular transport.
22211 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22212 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22213 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22216 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22218 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22219 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22220 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22221 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22223 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22224 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22225 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22226 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22229 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22230 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22231 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22233 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22234 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22235 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22236 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22237 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22238 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22239 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22241 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22242 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22243 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22244 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22245 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22249 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22250 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22253 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22254 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22255 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22256 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22257 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22258 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22259 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22260 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22261 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22263 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22264 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22265 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22267 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22268 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22269 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22270 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22271 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22272 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22273 of pattern they are set as follows:
22276 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22277 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22278 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22281 *queen@*.fict.example
22283 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22285 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22289 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22290 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22293 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22294 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22295 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22296 rewriting rule of the form
22298 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22300 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22306 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22307 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22308 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22309 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22310 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22314 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22315 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22316 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22317 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22318 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22320 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22322 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22325 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22326 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22327 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22328 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22329 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22330 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22331 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22332 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22333 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22334 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22335 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22336 entry written to the panic log.
22340 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22341 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22344 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22347 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22349 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22352 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22353 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22357 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22359 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22360 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22361 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22362 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22363 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22364 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22366 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22367 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22368 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22369 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22370 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22371 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22372 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22373 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22374 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22375 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22377 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22378 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22379 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22381 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22382 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22385 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22386 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22387 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22388 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22389 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22390 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22391 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22392 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22393 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22395 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22396 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22397 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22398 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22399 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22400 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22401 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22402 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22405 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22406 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22407 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22408 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22411 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22412 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22413 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22415 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22416 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22417 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22418 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22420 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22421 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22422 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22424 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22425 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22426 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22427 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22429 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22433 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22436 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22437 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22438 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22439 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22440 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22441 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22442 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22443 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22445 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22446 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22450 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22451 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22453 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22454 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22455 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22457 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22458 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22459 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22460 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22461 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22462 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22463 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22464 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22466 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22467 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22469 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22471 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22472 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22474 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22475 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22476 messages that originate outside the local host:
22478 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22479 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22481 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22484 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22485 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22486 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22487 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22488 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22489 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22490 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22491 components. For example, the rule
22493 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22495 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22496 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22497 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22498 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22499 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22500 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22501 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22508 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22511 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22512 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22513 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22514 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22515 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22516 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22517 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22518 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22519 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22520 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22521 address, domain and error.
22523 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22524 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22525 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22526 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22527 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22528 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22529 log selector is set, the message
22530 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22531 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22532 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22533 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22535 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22536 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22537 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22538 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22539 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22540 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22541 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22542 domain are maintained independently.
22544 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22545 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22546 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22547 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22548 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22549 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22550 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22551 the local address is reached.
22553 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22554 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22555 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22556 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22557 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22559 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22560 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22561 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22562 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22563 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22564 messages that it should now be retaining.
22568 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22569 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22570 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22571 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22572 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22573 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22574 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22575 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22576 message's sender, respectively.
22579 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22580 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22581 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22582 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22583 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22584 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22587 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22589 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22592 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22594 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22595 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22598 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22599 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22600 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22601 expressions work in address lists.
22603 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22604 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22608 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22609 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22610 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22611 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22612 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22613 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22614 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22615 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22616 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22618 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22619 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22620 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22621 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22624 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22625 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22626 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22627 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22628 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22629 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22630 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22631 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22632 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22633 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22638 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22640 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22641 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22642 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22643 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22644 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22645 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22647 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22651 and the retry rules are
22653 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22654 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22656 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22657 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22658 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22659 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22660 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22661 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22663 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22664 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22665 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22666 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22668 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22669 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22670 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22672 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22674 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22675 textual form of the IP address.
22677 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22678 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22679 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22680 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22683 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
22684 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22685 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22687 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
22688 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22689 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22691 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22692 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22694 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22695 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22698 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22699 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22700 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22701 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22702 retry rule of this form:
22704 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22706 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22707 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22710 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
22711 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22712 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22713 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22715 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
22716 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22718 .vitem &%refused_A%&
22719 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22722 A connection was refused.
22724 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22725 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22727 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22728 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22730 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22731 A connection attempt timed out.
22733 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22734 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22735 obtained from an MX record.
22737 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
22738 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22739 obtained from an MX record.
22742 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22744 .vitem &%tls_required%&
22745 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22746 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22747 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22750 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22753 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22754 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22755 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
22756 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22757 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
22758 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
22762 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
22763 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
22764 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
22765 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
22766 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
22770 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
22771 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
22772 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22774 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
22775 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
22776 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22777 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22778 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22779 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
22780 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22782 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22783 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22786 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22787 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
22788 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22793 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
22794 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
22795 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22796 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22797 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22800 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
22802 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22804 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
22806 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
22807 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
22810 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22812 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
22813 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
22814 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
22815 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
22816 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
22818 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
22819 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
22821 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22823 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
22824 list is never matched.
22830 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
22831 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
22832 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22833 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22835 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
22837 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22838 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22839 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22840 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22841 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22843 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
22844 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
22845 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
22846 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
22847 The available algorithms are:
22850 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22853 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22854 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22855 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22857 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
22858 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
22859 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
22860 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
22861 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
22862 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
22863 queue processing times.
22866 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22867 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22868 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22869 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22870 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22871 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22872 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22873 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
22874 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
22875 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
22876 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
22877 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
22879 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22880 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22881 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22882 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22883 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22884 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22887 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
22888 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22889 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22890 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22891 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22892 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22893 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22894 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22895 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22896 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22897 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22898 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22900 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22901 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
22902 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
22903 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
22904 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
22905 deliveries that have been deferred.
22908 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
22909 Here are some example retry rules:
22911 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22912 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22913 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22914 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22915 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22916 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22918 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22919 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
22920 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22921 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22922 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
22923 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22924 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22927 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
22928 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22929 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22930 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22931 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22933 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
22934 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22935 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22936 were not obtained from an MX record.
22938 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22939 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22940 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22941 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22942 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22946 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
22947 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
22948 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
22949 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
22950 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
22951 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22952 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22953 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22954 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22955 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
22956 failing for the first time.
22958 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
22959 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
22960 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
22961 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
22963 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
22964 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
22965 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
22970 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
22971 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
22972 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
22973 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
22974 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
22975 default retry rule:
22977 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
22979 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
22980 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
22981 failure for the recipient address that counts.
22983 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
22984 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
22985 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
22986 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
22987 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
22989 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
22990 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
22991 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
22993 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
22994 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
22995 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
22996 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
22997 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
22998 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
22999 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23000 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23002 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23003 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23004 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23005 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23006 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23009 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23010 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23011 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23012 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23013 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23014 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23015 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23016 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23017 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23020 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23021 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23022 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23023 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23024 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23025 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23026 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23027 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23030 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23031 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23032 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23033 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23034 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23035 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23036 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23037 time out the address.
23039 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23040 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23041 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23042 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23043 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23044 considered immediately.
23045 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23046 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23053 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23054 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23056 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23057 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23058 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23059 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23060 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23061 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23062 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23063 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23064 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23067 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23068 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23071 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23072 the client's EHLO command.
23074 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23075 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23077 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23078 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23079 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23080 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23081 with the AUTH command.
23083 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23085 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23086 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23087 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23090 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23091 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23092 unauthenticated connection.
23095 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23096 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23097 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23098 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23100 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23101 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23102 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23103 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
23104 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23105 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23106 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23107 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23112 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23113 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23114 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23115 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23116 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23117 included by setting
23120 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23124 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23125 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23126 the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23127 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23128 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23129 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23131 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23132 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23133 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23134 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23135 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23136 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23137 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23139 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23140 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23141 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23142 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23143 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23144 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23148 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23149 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23151 client_secret = secret2
23153 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23154 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23156 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23157 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23158 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23163 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23164 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23165 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23167 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23168 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23169 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23170 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23171 encrypted by a setting such as:
23173 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23175 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23176 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23177 cipher used for the delivery.)
23180 .option driver authenticators string unset
23181 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23182 authenticators is to be used.
23185 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23186 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23187 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23188 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23189 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23190 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23193 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23194 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23195 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23196 mechanism is not advertised.
23197 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23198 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23199 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23202 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23203 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23204 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23207 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23208 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23209 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23210 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23211 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23212 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23213 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23214 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23215 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23219 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23220 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23221 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23222 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23223 out the values of variables.
23224 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23225 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23228 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23229 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23230 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23231 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23232 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23233 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23234 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23235 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23236 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23239 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23240 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23241 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23242 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23243 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23244 remembered for later use.
23245 How it is used is described in the following section.
23251 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23252 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23253 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23254 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23255 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23259 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23260 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23262 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23264 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23265 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23266 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23267 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23268 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23269 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23270 given for the MAIL command.
23272 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23273 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23276 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23277 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23278 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23279 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23280 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23281 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23282 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23287 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23288 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23289 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23290 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23292 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23293 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23294 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23295 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23296 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23301 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23302 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23303 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23304 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23308 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23310 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23311 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23314 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23315 the mechanisms are advertised.
23317 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23318 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23319 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23320 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23321 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23322 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23323 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23325 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23327 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23329 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23330 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23331 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23334 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23336 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23337 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23338 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23340 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23341 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23342 command. This is the case if
23345 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23347 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23349 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23350 server authenticators.
23354 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23355 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23356 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23358 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23359 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23360 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23361 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23362 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23363 rejected with a 504 error.
23365 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23366 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23367 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23368 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23369 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23370 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23371 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23372 no successful authentication.
23377 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23378 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23379 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23380 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23381 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23382 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23383 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23387 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23389 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23390 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23391 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23392 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23393 command line to run this script on such data might be
23395 encode '\0user\0password'
23397 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23398 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23399 whose code value is zero.
23401 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23402 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23403 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23404 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23406 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23407 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23408 example, a command such as
23410 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23412 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23414 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23415 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23417 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23419 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23420 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23421 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23422 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23426 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23427 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23428 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23429 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23430 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23431 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23434 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23435 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23436 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23437 of the authenticator.
23440 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23441 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23442 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23443 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23444 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23445 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23446 delivery to be deferred.
23448 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23449 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23450 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23453 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23454 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23455 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23456 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23457 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23458 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23459 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23460 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23461 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23464 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23465 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23466 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23467 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23468 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23469 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23470 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23471 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23472 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23473 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23474 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23475 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23476 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23483 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23484 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23486 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23487 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23488 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23489 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23490 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23491 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23492 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23493 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23494 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23495 connections as you do for login accounts.
23497 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23498 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23499 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23501 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23502 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23503 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23505 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23506 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23507 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23510 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23511 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23512 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23513 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23514 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23515 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23516 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23518 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23519 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23520 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23521 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23522 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23523 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23524 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23526 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23527 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23528 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23529 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23531 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23532 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23533 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23535 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23536 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23537 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23538 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23539 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23540 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23541 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23542 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23543 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23544 string as the error text.
23546 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23547 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23548 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23552 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23553 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23554 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23555 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23556 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23557 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23558 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23559 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23561 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23562 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23563 configured as follows:
23567 public_name = PLAIN
23569 server_condition = \
23570 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23571 server_set_id = $auth2
23573 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23574 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23575 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23576 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23578 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23579 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23580 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23581 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23585 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23587 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23589 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23590 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23594 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23595 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23597 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23598 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23599 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23600 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23601 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23603 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23604 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23605 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23607 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23608 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23609 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23610 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23611 This is an incorrect example:
23613 server_condition = \
23614 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23616 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23617 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23618 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23619 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23620 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23621 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23622 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23624 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23625 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23627 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23628 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23629 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23630 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23631 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23634 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23635 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23636 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23637 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23638 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23639 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23640 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23644 public_name = LOGIN
23645 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23646 server_condition = \
23647 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23648 server_set_id = $auth1
23650 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23651 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23652 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23653 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23655 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23656 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23657 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23658 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23659 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23663 public_name = LOGIN
23664 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23665 server_condition = ${if and{{
23667 ldapauth{user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23668 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23669 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
23670 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23672 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
23673 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
23674 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
23675 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
23676 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
23677 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
23678 uninterpreted string.
23681 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23682 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23683 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23684 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23685 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23691 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23692 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23693 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23695 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23696 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23697 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23698 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23701 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23702 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23703 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23704 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23705 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23706 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23707 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23708 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23709 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23710 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23711 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23712 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23714 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23715 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23717 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23718 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23719 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23720 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23723 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23724 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23728 public_name = PLAIN
23729 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23731 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23732 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23733 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23737 public_name = LOGIN
23738 client_send = : username : mysecret
23740 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23741 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23743 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23744 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23749 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23750 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23752 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23753 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23754 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23755 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
23756 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
23757 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23758 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23759 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23760 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23761 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23762 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23763 available in plain text at either end.
23766 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
23767 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
23768 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23769 authenticator as a server:
23771 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23772 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23773 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23774 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
23775 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
23776 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
23777 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
23778 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
23779 returned to the client.
23781 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
23782 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
23783 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
23784 numeric variables for other things.
23786 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23787 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
23788 user name, authentication fails.
23792 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23793 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23794 server_set_id = $auth1
23796 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23797 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
23798 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
23799 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
23803 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23804 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
23806 server_set_id = $auth1
23808 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23809 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
23812 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
23813 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
23814 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
23818 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
23819 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23820 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23823 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23824 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23825 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23829 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23830 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23831 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
23832 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
23833 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
23834 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
23835 send the message to the current server.
23837 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
23842 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23844 client_secret = secret
23846 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
23847 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
23851 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23852 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23854 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
23855 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
23856 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
23857 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
23859 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23860 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
23862 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23863 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
23864 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
23865 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
23866 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23868 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23869 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23870 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
23871 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23873 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23874 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
23875 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23876 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23877 depending on the driver you are using.
23879 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
23880 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
23881 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
23882 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
23883 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
23884 implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
23885 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
23886 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
23887 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
23890 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
23891 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
23892 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
23893 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
23894 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
23895 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
23899 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
23900 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
23901 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
23902 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
23905 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
23906 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
23907 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
23908 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
23912 driver = cyrus_sasl
23913 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23914 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23915 server_set_id = $auth1
23918 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
23919 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23922 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
23923 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23926 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23927 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23928 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23929 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23932 driver = cyrus_sasl
23933 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23934 server_set_id = $auth1
23937 driver = cyrus_sasl
23938 public_name = PLAIN
23939 server_set_id = $auth2
23941 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23942 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23943 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23944 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
23945 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
23950 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23951 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23952 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
23953 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
23954 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
23955 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
23956 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
23957 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
23958 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
23959 authenticator only. There is only one option:
23961 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
23963 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
23964 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
23965 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
23966 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
23970 public_name = PLAIN
23971 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23972 server_set_id = $auth2
23977 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23978 server_set_id = $auth1
23980 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
23981 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
23982 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
23983 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
23984 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
23985 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
23986 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
23987 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
23990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23991 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23993 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
23994 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
23995 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
23996 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
23997 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
23998 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
23999 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
24000 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
24001 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
24002 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
24003 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
24004 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
24005 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
24009 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
24010 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
24012 The server sends back a challenge.
24014 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
24015 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
24018 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
24022 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
24023 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
24024 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
24026 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
24027 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
24028 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
24029 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
24030 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
24031 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
24032 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
24033 for other things. For example:
24038 server_password = \
24039 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24041 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24042 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24048 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24049 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24050 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24054 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24055 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24058 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
24059 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
24062 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
24063 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
24064 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24070 client_username = msn/msn_username
24071 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24072 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24074 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
24075 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
24081 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24084 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24085 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24086 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24087 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24088 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24091 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24092 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24093 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24094 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24095 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24096 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24097 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24098 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24099 certificates are used.
24101 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24102 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24103 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24104 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24105 between them is encrypted.
24107 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24108 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24109 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24110 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24113 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24114 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24115 in order to get TLS to work.
24119 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24121 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24122 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24123 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24124 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24125 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24126 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24127 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24128 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24129 allocated for this purpose.
24131 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24132 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24133 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24134 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24136 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24138 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24139 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24140 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24141 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24142 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24145 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24146 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24153 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24154 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24155 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24156 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24157 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24161 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24165 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24166 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24168 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24171 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24172 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24174 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24175 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24176 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24178 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24179 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24180 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24181 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24183 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24184 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24185 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24186 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24187 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24188 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24191 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24192 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24196 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24197 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24198 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24199 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24200 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24201 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
24202 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24203 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24204 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24205 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24206 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24208 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24209 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24210 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24211 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24212 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24213 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24214 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24215 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24217 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24218 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24219 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24221 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24222 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24223 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24224 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24228 # chown exim:exim new-params
24229 # chmod 0400 new-params
24230 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24231 # echo "" >>new-params
24232 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24233 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24235 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24236 stalling is removed.
24239 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24240 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24241 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24242 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24243 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24244 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24245 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24246 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24247 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24250 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24252 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24253 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24254 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24257 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24258 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24259 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24263 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24266 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24267 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24270 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24271 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24273 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24274 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24277 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24278 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24279 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24280 not be moved to the end of the list.
24285 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24287 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24288 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24289 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24290 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24291 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24292 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24293 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24294 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24295 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24296 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24297 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24298 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24299 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24300 passed to its control function.
24302 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24303 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24304 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24305 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24306 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24307 the same as if just AES were given.
24309 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24310 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24311 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24312 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24313 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24314 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24315 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24317 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24318 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24319 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24320 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24321 can be changed in the usual way.
24323 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24324 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24325 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24326 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24327 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24329 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24330 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24331 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24332 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24334 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24336 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24338 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24340 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24342 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24343 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24344 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24345 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24347 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24348 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24349 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24351 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24352 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24354 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
24355 The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
24357 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24358 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24359 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24360 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24361 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24366 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24367 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24368 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24369 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24370 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24371 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24372 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24373 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24375 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24376 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24377 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24380 554 Security failure
24382 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24383 rejected with a 554 error code.
24385 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24386 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24387 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24388 without some further configuration at the server end.
24390 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24391 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24393 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24394 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24396 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24397 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24398 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24399 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24400 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24401 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24402 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24403 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24404 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24405 the server's certificate.
24407 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24408 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24409 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24411 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24412 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24413 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24416 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24417 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24418 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24420 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24422 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24423 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24424 suites that the server supports. See the command
24428 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24429 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24431 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24432 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24433 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24434 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24435 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24437 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24438 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24439 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24440 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24441 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24442 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24443 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24444 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24445 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24446 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24449 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24450 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24451 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24452 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24453 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24454 documentation for more details.
24457 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24458 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24459 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24460 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24461 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24462 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24463 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24464 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24465 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24466 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24467 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24468 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24470 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24473 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24474 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24475 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24477 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24479 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24481 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24482 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24483 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24484 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24485 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24486 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24487 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24488 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24489 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24490 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24492 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24493 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24494 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24495 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24497 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24498 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24499 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24500 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24501 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24502 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24505 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24506 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24507 .cindex "revocation list"
24508 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24509 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24510 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24511 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24512 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24513 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24517 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24518 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24519 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24520 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24521 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24522 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24523 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24524 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24525 within the &(smtp)& transport.
24527 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24528 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24529 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24530 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24531 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24533 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24534 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24535 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24536 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24537 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24540 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24541 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24542 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24543 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24544 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24545 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24546 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24547 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24548 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24549 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24552 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24553 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24554 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24555 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
24557 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
24558 must name a file or,
24559 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24560 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24561 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24562 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24565 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24566 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24567 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24568 alternative hosts, if any.
24571 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24572 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24573 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24577 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24578 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24579 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24580 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24581 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24583 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24584 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24585 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24586 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24587 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24588 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24589 outgoing connection.
24593 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24595 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24596 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24597 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24598 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24599 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24600 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24601 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24602 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24603 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24604 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24605 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24607 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24608 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24609 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24610 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24611 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24612 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24613 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24614 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24615 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24617 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24618 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24619 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24620 information is recorded.
24622 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24623 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24624 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24629 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24630 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24631 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24632 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24633 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24634 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24635 to Apache, currently at
24637 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24639 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24640 links to further files.
24641 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24642 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24643 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24645 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24649 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24650 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24651 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24652 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24653 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24654 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24655 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24656 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24657 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24658 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24659 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24660 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24661 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24664 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24665 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24666 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24667 with OpenSSL, like this:
24669 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24672 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24673 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24674 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24675 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24676 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24677 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24678 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24680 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24681 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24682 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24684 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24685 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24686 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24687 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24688 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24689 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24691 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24692 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24693 Open-source PKI book, available online at
24694 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24695 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24696 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24703 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24704 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24705 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
24706 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24707 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24708 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24709 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24710 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24711 one very small ACL:
24715 accept hosts = one.host.only
24717 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24718 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24720 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24721 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24722 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24723 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24724 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24725 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24726 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24727 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24730 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24731 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24732 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24733 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24734 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24738 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24739 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24740 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24741 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24742 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24743 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24744 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24745 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24746 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24747 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24748 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24749 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24750 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
24751 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
24752 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
24753 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24754 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24755 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
24758 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
24759 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
24760 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
24761 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
24762 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
24763 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
24764 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
24765 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
24766 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
24767 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
24768 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
24769 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
24770 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
24771 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
24772 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
24773 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
24774 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
24775 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
24778 For example, if you set
24780 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24782 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24783 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24784 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24785 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24786 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24787 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24788 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24791 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
24792 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24793 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
24794 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
24795 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
24796 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
24797 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
24798 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
24799 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
24800 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
24801 in any of these ACLs.
24803 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
24804 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
24805 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
24806 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
24807 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
24808 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
24809 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
24810 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
24812 control = suppress_local_fixups
24814 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
24815 run, it is too late.
24817 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24818 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24820 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
24821 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24822 temporary error for these kinds of message.
24825 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
24826 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24827 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
24828 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
24829 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
24830 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
24831 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
24832 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
24833 &%smtp_banner%& option.
24836 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
24837 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24838 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24839 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
24840 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
24841 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
24842 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
24843 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
24844 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
24846 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
24847 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
24848 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
24849 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
24853 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
24854 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24855 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24856 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24857 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
24858 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24859 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24860 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24861 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24862 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
24864 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24865 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24866 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24867 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24868 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
24869 associated with the DATA command.
24871 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24872 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24873 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
24874 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
24875 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24879 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
24880 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24881 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24884 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
24885 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24886 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
24887 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
24888 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
24889 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
24891 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24892 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24893 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24894 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
24896 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
24897 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
24899 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
24900 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24903 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24904 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24905 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24906 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24907 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24910 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
24911 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
24912 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
24913 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
24914 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
24915 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
24916 situation even worse.
24918 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
24919 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
24920 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
24923 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
24924 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
24925 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
24926 connection. The possible values are:
24928 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
24929 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
24930 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
24931 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
24932 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
24933 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
24934 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
24935 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
24936 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
24937 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
24939 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
24940 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
24941 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
24942 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
24943 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
24947 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
24948 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
24949 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
24950 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
24952 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
24953 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
24955 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
24956 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
24957 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
24958 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
24959 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
24961 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
24962 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
24963 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
24966 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
24967 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
24968 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
24969 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
24970 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
24971 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
24973 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
24974 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
24975 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
24977 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
24978 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
24979 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
24980 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
24982 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
24983 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
24984 matches the string.
24986 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
24987 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
24988 want to have something like
24990 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
24992 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
24993 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
24999 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
25000 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
25001 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
25002 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
25003 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
25004 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
25005 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
25006 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
25007 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
25009 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
25010 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
25011 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
25014 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
25015 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
25016 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
25017 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
25019 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
25020 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
25021 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
25022 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
25023 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
25024 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
25025 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
25028 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
25029 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
25030 recipients; it may create new recipients.
25034 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
25035 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
25036 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
25037 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
25038 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
25039 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
25041 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
25042 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
25043 used to accept or reject anything.
25045 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
25046 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
25047 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
25048 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
25050 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
25051 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
25052 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
25053 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
25054 configuration file.
25059 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
25060 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
25062 .vindex &$local_part$&
25063 .vindex &$sender_address$&
25064 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
25065 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25066 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
25067 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
25068 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
25069 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
25070 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
25071 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25073 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
25074 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
25075 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
25078 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
25079 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
25080 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
25081 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
25082 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
25085 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
25086 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
25087 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
25088 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
25089 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
25090 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
25091 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
25092 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
25098 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25099 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25100 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25101 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25102 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25103 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25104 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25105 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25106 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25107 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25108 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25109 unencrypted connections.
25112 accept encrypted = *
25113 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25115 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25117 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25118 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25119 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25120 option to do this.)
25124 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25125 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25126 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25127 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25128 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25129 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25130 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25132 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25133 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25134 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25137 deny dnslists = list1.example
25138 dnslists = list2.example
25140 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25141 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25142 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25143 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25144 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25147 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25148 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25151 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25152 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25153 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25154 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25155 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25156 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25157 check a RCPT command:
25159 accept domains = +local_domains
25163 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25164 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25165 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25166 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25169 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25170 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25171 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25174 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25175 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25176 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25177 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25178 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25179 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25181 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25182 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25184 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25185 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25186 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25188 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25189 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25190 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25195 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25196 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25197 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25198 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25199 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25200 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25201 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25205 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25206 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25207 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25210 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25212 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25216 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25217 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25218 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25219 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25220 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25221 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25222 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25223 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25224 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
25226 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25227 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25228 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25232 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25233 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25234 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25236 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25237 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25239 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25240 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25243 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25244 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25245 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25246 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25248 require message = Sender did not verify
25251 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25252 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25253 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25254 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25257 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25258 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25259 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25260 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25261 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25262 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25263 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25265 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25266 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25267 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25268 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25269 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25271 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25272 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25273 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25274 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25275 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25276 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25280 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25281 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25282 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25283 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25285 warn !verify = sender
25286 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25290 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25292 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25293 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25294 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25295 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25296 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25300 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25301 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25302 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25303 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25304 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25305 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25306 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25307 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25308 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25309 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25311 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25312 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25313 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25314 on the same SMTP connection.
25316 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25317 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25318 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25321 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25322 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25323 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25325 accept hosts = whatever
25326 set acl_m4 = some value
25327 accept authenticated = *
25328 set acl_c_auth = yes
25330 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25331 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25332 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25334 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25335 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25336 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25337 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25338 error is generated.
25340 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25341 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25344 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25345 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25346 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25347 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25349 deny domains = *.dom.example
25350 !verify = recipient
25352 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25353 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25354 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25355 two statements are equivalent:
25357 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25358 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25360 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25361 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25363 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25364 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25365 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25367 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25368 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25369 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25370 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25372 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25373 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25374 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25375 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25376 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25377 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25378 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25380 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25381 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25382 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25383 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25384 message is handled.
25386 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25387 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25388 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25389 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25391 require message = Can't verify sender
25393 message = Can't verify recipient
25395 message = This message cannot be used
25397 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25398 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25399 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25400 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25401 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25402 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25404 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25405 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25406 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25407 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25410 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25411 message = Invalid sender from client host
25413 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25414 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25418 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25419 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25420 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25423 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25424 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25425 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25426 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25428 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25429 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25430 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25431 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25432 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25433 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25434 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25435 write rather ugly lines like this:
25437 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25439 Instead, all you need is
25441 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25444 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25445 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25446 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25447 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25448 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25449 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25450 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25451 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25453 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25454 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25455 in several different ways. For example:
25457 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25458 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25459 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25463 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25465 accept ...some conditions
25466 control = queue_only
25468 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25469 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25472 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25474 accept ...some conditions...
25475 control = queue_only
25476 ...some more conditions...
25478 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25479 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25480 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25484 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25485 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25488 warn ...some conditions...
25492 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25493 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25497 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25498 &%require%& verb. For example:
25500 require control = no_multiline_responses
25504 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25505 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25507 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25508 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25509 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25510 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25511 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25512 flushed before the delay is imposed.
25514 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25517 deny ...some conditions...
25520 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25521 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
25524 ...some conditions...
25526 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25527 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25529 warn ...some conditions...
25535 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25536 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25537 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25538 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25539 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25540 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25541 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25545 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25546 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25547 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25548 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25549 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25550 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25551 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25554 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25555 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25556 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25557 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25559 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25560 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25562 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25565 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25566 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25568 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25569 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25570 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25573 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25574 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25575 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25576 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25577 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25578 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25581 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25582 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25583 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25586 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25587 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25588 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25589 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25590 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25591 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25593 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25594 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25595 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25596 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25597 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25598 logging rejections.
25601 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25602 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25603 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25604 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25605 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25606 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25607 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25608 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25610 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25611 &` log_reject_target =`&
25613 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25614 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
25618 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25619 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25620 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25621 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25622 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25623 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25624 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25627 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25628 &` control = freeze`&
25629 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25631 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25632 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25633 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25636 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25637 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25641 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25642 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25643 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25644 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25645 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25646 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25647 &%accept%& for details.)
25649 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25650 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25651 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25652 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25653 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25655 require message = Host not recognized
25658 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25661 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25662 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25663 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25664 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25665 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25666 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25667 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25668 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25669 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25672 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25673 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25674 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25676 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25677 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25679 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25680 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25681 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
25684 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25685 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25687 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25688 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25689 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25692 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25693 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25694 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25695 However, the original message is available in the variable
25696 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25697 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25698 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25699 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25701 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25702 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25703 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25704 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25705 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25706 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25710 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25711 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25712 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25713 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25720 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25721 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25722 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25725 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25726 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25727 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25728 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25729 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25730 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25731 not work without it. For example:
25733 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25734 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25736 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25737 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25738 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
25739 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
25740 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
25743 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
25744 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
25745 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
25746 .cindex "case of local parts"
25747 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25748 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
25749 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
25750 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
25751 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
25752 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
25755 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25756 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25757 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25758 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25759 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
25761 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25762 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
25765 warn control = caseful_local_part
25766 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25768 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25770 control = caselower_local_part
25772 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25773 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25775 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
25776 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
25777 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
25778 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
25779 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
25780 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
25781 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
25782 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
25783 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
25787 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
25788 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
25789 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
25792 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
25793 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
25794 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
25795 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
25796 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25797 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
25798 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25799 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25801 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25802 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25803 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25804 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25805 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25806 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25810 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
25811 .cindex "fake defer"
25812 .cindex "defer, fake"
25813 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
25814 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
25815 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
25816 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
25817 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
25819 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
25820 .cindex "fake rejection"
25821 .cindex "rejection, fake"
25822 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25823 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25824 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25825 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25826 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25827 the same SMTP connection.
25829 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
25830 message is supplied, the following is used:
25832 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25833 550-kept for evaluation.
25834 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25835 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25837 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
25839 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
25840 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
25841 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25842 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25843 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25844 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25847 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
25848 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
25849 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
25850 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
25852 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
25853 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
25854 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
25855 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25856 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
25857 disables such output flushing.
25859 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
25860 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
25861 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
25862 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25863 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
25864 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
25866 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
25867 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25868 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25869 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25870 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25871 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25872 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25873 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25874 to be useful in production.
25876 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
25877 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
25878 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25879 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25880 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25882 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25883 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25884 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25885 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
25886 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
25887 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25890 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25891 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
25892 verification failed"&) is sent.
25894 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25898 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25899 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25901 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
25902 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
25903 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
25904 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
25905 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
25906 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
25907 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
25909 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
25910 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
25911 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
25912 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25913 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25914 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25915 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25916 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
25917 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25918 same SMTP connection.
25920 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
25921 .cindex "message" "submission"
25922 .cindex "submission mode"
25923 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25924 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
25925 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25926 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
25927 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
25928 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
25929 late (the message has already been created).
25931 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
25932 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
25933 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
25934 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
25935 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
25937 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
25938 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
25939 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
25940 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
25941 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
25944 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
25945 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
25947 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
25949 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
25952 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
25953 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
25954 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
25955 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
25958 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
25959 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
25963 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
25964 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
25967 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
25969 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
25970 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
25972 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
25974 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
25979 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
25980 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
25981 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
25982 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25983 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
25984 to an incoming message, as in this example:
25986 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
25987 dialup.mail-abuse.org
25988 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
25990 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
25991 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
25992 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
25993 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
25994 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
25997 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
25998 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
25999 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
26000 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
26002 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
26003 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
26004 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
26005 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
26006 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
26007 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
26008 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
26009 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
26010 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
26011 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
26012 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
26014 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
26015 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
26016 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
26017 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
26018 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
26019 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
26020 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
26021 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
26022 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
26024 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
26025 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
26027 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26028 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
26030 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
26031 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26033 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
26034 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
26035 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
26036 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
26039 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26040 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
26041 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
26042 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
26043 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
26044 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
26045 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
26048 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
26049 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
26050 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
26051 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
26052 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
26054 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
26055 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
26056 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
26057 to be a header name first.) For example:
26059 warn add_header = \
26060 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
26062 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
26063 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
26064 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
26065 up in reverse order.
26067 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
26068 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
26069 system filter or in a router or transport.
26074 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
26075 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
26076 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
26077 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
26078 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
26079 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26081 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
26082 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
26083 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
26084 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
26085 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
26086 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
26087 The conditions are as follows:
26091 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
26092 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
26093 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
26094 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
26095 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
26096 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
26097 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
26098 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
26099 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
26100 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
26101 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
26103 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
26104 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
26105 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
26106 conditions are tested.
26108 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
26109 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
26110 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
26111 for different local users or different local domains.
26113 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26114 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26115 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26116 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26117 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26118 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26119 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26124 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26125 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26126 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26127 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26128 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26129 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26130 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26131 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26132 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26133 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26134 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26135 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26138 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26139 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26140 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26141 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26142 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26143 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26144 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26145 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26147 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26148 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26149 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26150 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26151 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26153 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26154 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26155 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26156 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26157 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26158 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26159 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26160 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26161 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26162 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26164 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26165 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26166 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26167 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26168 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26169 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26170 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26171 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26172 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26175 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26176 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26179 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26180 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26181 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26182 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26183 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26184 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26185 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26191 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26192 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26193 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26194 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26195 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26196 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26197 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26199 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26201 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26202 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26203 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26205 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26206 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26207 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26208 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26209 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26210 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26212 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26213 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26215 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26216 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26218 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26219 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26220 statement can then check the IP address.
26222 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26223 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26224 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26225 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26227 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26228 message = $host_data
26230 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26232 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26233 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26234 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26235 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26236 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26237 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26238 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26239 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26240 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26241 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26243 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26244 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26245 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26246 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26247 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26248 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26249 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26251 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26252 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26253 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26254 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26255 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26256 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26257 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26260 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26261 .cindex "rate limiting"
26262 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26263 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26265 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26266 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26267 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26268 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26269 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26270 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26272 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26273 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26274 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26275 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26276 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26277 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26278 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26280 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26281 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26282 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26283 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26284 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26285 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26286 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26287 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26288 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26289 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26290 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26291 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26292 influence the sender checking.
26294 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26295 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26297 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26298 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26299 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26300 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26301 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26302 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26306 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26307 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26309 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26310 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26311 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26312 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26313 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26314 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26316 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26317 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26318 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26319 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26320 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26321 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26322 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26323 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26324 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26325 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26327 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26328 .cindex "CSA verification"
26329 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26330 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26331 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26333 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26334 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26335 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26336 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26337 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26338 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26339 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26340 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26341 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26342 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26343 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26344 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26345 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26346 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26347 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26349 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26350 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26351 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26352 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26355 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26356 !verify = header_sender
26359 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26360 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26361 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26362 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26363 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26364 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26365 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26366 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26367 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26368 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26369 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26370 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26373 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26374 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26378 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26379 common as they used to be.
26381 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26382 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26383 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26384 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26385 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26386 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26387 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26388 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26389 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26390 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26391 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26392 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26393 independently of this condition.
26395 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26396 option), this condition is always true.
26399 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26400 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26401 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26402 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26403 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26404 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26405 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26406 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26407 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26409 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26410 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26413 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26414 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26415 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26416 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26417 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26418 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26419 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26420 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26421 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26422 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26423 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26424 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26425 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26426 value for the child address.
26428 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26429 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26430 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26431 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26432 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26433 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26434 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26435 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26436 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26437 original IP address.
26439 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26440 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26442 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26443 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26444 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26445 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
26446 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
26447 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26448 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26449 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26450 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26452 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26453 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26454 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26455 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26456 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26457 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26458 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26460 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26461 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26462 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26464 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26465 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26466 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26467 verified as a sender.
26472 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26473 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26474 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26475 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26476 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26477 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26478 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
26479 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
26480 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
26481 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26483 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26484 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26486 the following records are looked up:
26488 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26489 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26491 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26492 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26493 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26494 use two separate conditions:
26496 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26497 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26499 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26500 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26501 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26504 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26505 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26506 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26507 following special items in the list:
26509 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26510 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26511 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26513 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26514 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26515 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26516 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26518 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26520 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26521 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26523 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26524 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26525 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26527 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26528 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26529 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26530 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26534 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26535 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26536 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26537 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26538 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26540 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26542 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26543 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26544 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26545 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26550 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26551 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26552 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26553 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26554 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26555 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26556 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26558 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26559 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26561 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26562 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26563 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26564 up by this example is
26566 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26568 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26569 addresses. For example:
26571 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26572 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26574 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26575 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26580 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26581 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26582 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26583 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26584 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26585 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26586 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26587 either to double the separators like this:
26589 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26591 or to change the separator character, like this:
26593 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26595 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26596 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26597 occurs. Consider this condition:
26599 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26601 The DNS lookups that occur are:
26603 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26604 a.domain.black.list.tld
26606 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26607 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26608 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26609 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26610 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26611 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26612 error for a previous item.
26614 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26615 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26617 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26618 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26620 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26621 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26623 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26624 $sender_address_domain \
26625 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26627 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26628 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26629 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26631 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26632 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26633 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26634 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26636 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26638 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26639 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26641 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26642 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26647 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26648 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26649 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26650 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26651 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26652 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26656 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26658 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26659 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26660 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26662 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26663 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26664 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26667 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26668 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26669 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26670 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26671 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26672 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26673 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26674 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26675 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26676 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26677 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26678 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26679 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26680 cases, for example:
26682 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26684 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26685 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26686 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26687 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26689 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26691 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26692 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26694 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26695 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26696 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26697 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26698 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26701 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26702 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26703 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26705 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26706 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26708 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26713 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26714 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26715 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26716 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26719 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26721 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26722 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26723 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26724 describes how multiple records are handled.
26726 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26727 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26728 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26730 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26732 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26733 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26734 first. For example:
26736 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26737 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26740 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
26741 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
26742 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26743 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26744 tested. For example:
26746 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26748 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
26749 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26750 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26752 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26754 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26759 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
26760 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
26763 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26765 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26766 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
26768 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26770 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26771 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
26772 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26773 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
26775 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26776 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26778 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26779 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26781 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26782 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26784 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26785 Consider this example:
26787 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26789 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26792 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26794 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26796 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26797 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26798 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26800 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26805 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
26806 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
26807 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
26808 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
26809 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
26810 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
26812 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
26814 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
26815 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
26816 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
26817 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
26818 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
26819 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
26822 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
26823 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
26824 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26826 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
26827 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
26830 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
26832 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26833 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
26835 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
26837 for the condition to be true.
26840 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
26841 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
26843 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
26844 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
26846 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
26848 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26849 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26851 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
26852 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
26854 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
26856 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26857 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
26859 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26861 for the condition to be false.
26863 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
26864 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
26869 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
26870 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
26871 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
26872 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
26873 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
26874 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
26875 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
26876 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
26877 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
26880 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
26881 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
26882 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
26883 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
26884 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
26885 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
26886 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
26889 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
26890 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
26892 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
26893 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26895 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
26896 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
26897 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
26898 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
26899 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
26900 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
26902 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
26903 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
26904 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
26906 reject dnslists = \
26907 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
26908 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
26909 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
26910 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26912 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
26913 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
26914 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
26918 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
26919 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
26920 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
26921 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26922 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26923 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26925 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26926 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26928 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26929 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26930 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26932 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26934 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26935 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26937 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26938 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
26940 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26941 dnslists = some.list.example
26944 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
26945 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
26946 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
26947 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
26948 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
26949 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
26950 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
26951 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
26952 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
26953 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
26955 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
26957 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
26958 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
26960 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
26961 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
26962 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
26965 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
26966 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
26967 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
26968 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
26969 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
26970 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
26971 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
26972 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
26973 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
26975 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
26976 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
26977 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
26978 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
26980 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
26981 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
26982 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
26983 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
26984 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
26985 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
26986 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
26987 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
26988 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
26989 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
26991 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
26992 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
26993 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
26996 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options onto the
26997 lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
26998 for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
26999 still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
27000 parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
27002 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
27003 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
27004 handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
27005 disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
27006 The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
27007 appear in any order.
27009 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
27010 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
27012 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
27013 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified.
27015 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
27016 best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
27017 relies on the SIZE parameter specified by the client in its MAIL command,
27018 which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'&
27019 in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes,
27020 megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
27022 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which
27023 recipients are accepted. To be effective, it would need to be used in
27024 either the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& or the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. In the
27025 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACL, the number of recipients is incremented by one.
27026 In the case of a locally submitted message in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL,
27027 the number of recipients is incremented by the &%$recipients_count%&
27028 for the entire message. Note that in either case the rate limiting
27029 engine will see a message with many recipients as a large high-speed
27032 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
27033 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate.
27034 This command is essentially an alias of &%per_rcpt%& to make it clear
27035 that the effect is to limit the rate at which individual commands,
27036 rather than recipients, are accepted.
27038 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
27039 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
27040 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
27041 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
27042 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
27043 rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
27044 over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
27046 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
27047 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
27048 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
27049 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
27050 counter-measures by the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate. If
27051 the client stops attempting to send email for the time specified in the &'p'&
27052 parameter then its computed rate will decay exponentially to 37% of its peak
27053 value. You can work out the time (the number of smoothing periods) that a
27054 client is subjected to counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this
27057 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
27059 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
27060 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
27061 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
27062 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
27063 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
27064 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
27065 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
27067 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
27068 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
27069 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
27070 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
27071 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
27072 message. For example:
27074 # Log all senders' rates
27075 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
27076 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
27078 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
27079 # at the decimal point.
27080 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
27081 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
27082 $sender_rate_limit }s
27084 # Keep authenticated users under control
27085 deny authenticated = *
27086 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
27088 # System-wide rate limit
27089 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
27090 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
27092 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
27093 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
27094 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
27095 messages per $sender_rate_period
27096 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
27097 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
27098 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
27100 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
27101 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
27102 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
27103 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
27104 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
27105 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
27106 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
27109 .section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
27110 .cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
27111 If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
27112 computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
27113 saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
27114 existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
27115 the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
27116 entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
27120 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd / noupdate
27121 log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27122 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27125 &'... some other logic and tests...'&
27129 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
27130 condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
27131 logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27132 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27134 In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
27135 high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
27136 happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
27140 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27141 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27142 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27143 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27144 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27145 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27146 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27147 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27148 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27150 verify = sender/callout
27151 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27153 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27154 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27155 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27156 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27157 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27158 The available options are as follows:
27161 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27162 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27163 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27165 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27166 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27167 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27168 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27170 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27171 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27173 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27174 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27175 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27176 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27179 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27180 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27181 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27182 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27183 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27184 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27187 warn !verify = sender
27188 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27190 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27191 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27192 verification failure.
27194 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27195 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27198 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27199 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27201 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27203 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27204 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27205 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27207 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27209 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27212 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27213 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27218 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27219 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27220 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27221 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27222 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27223 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27224 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27225 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27226 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27227 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27228 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27229 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27232 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27233 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27234 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27235 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27236 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27237 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27239 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27240 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27241 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27242 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27243 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27245 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27246 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27247 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27248 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27249 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27250 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27251 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27252 supplies a host list.
27254 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27255 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27256 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27257 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27258 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27259 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27260 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27262 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27263 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27264 following SMTP commands are sent:
27266 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27268 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27271 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27274 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27275 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27276 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27277 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27278 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27279 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27281 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27282 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27283 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27284 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27285 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27287 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27288 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27289 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27290 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27291 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27296 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27297 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27298 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27299 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27301 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27303 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27304 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27305 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27309 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27310 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27311 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27314 verify = sender/callout=5s
27316 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27317 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27318 the &%connect%& parameter.
27321 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27322 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27323 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27324 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27326 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27328 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27330 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
27331 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27332 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27333 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27334 updated in this circumstance.
27336 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27337 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27338 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27339 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27340 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27341 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27344 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27345 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27346 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27347 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27348 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27349 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27350 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27351 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27352 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27353 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27355 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27357 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27360 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27361 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27362 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27365 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27367 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27368 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27369 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27370 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27371 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
27374 .vitem &*no_cache*&
27375 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27376 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27377 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27379 .vitem &*postmaster*&
27380 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27381 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27382 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27383 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27384 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27385 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27386 made, until the cache record expires.
27388 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27389 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27390 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27393 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27395 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27396 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27398 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27400 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27401 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27402 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27403 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27407 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27408 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27409 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27410 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27411 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27413 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27415 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27416 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27417 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27418 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27419 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27421 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27422 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27423 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27425 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27427 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27428 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27429 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27430 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27431 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27433 .vitem &*use_sender*&
27434 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27436 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27438 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27439 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27440 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27441 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27442 usefulness of callout caching.
27445 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27446 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27447 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27448 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27449 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27450 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27451 these circumstances.
27453 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27454 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27455 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27456 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27457 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27458 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27459 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27461 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27462 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27463 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27464 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27469 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27470 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27471 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27472 .cindex "caching" "callout"
27473 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27474 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27475 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27476 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27477 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27478 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27480 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27481 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27484 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27485 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27486 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27488 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27489 commands up to and including
27493 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27494 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27495 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27496 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27497 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27498 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27499 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27501 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27502 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27503 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27504 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27505 will eventually be noticed.
27507 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27508 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27509 behaviour will be the same.
27513 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27514 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27515 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27516 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27517 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27518 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27521 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27523 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27524 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27525 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27526 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27527 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27528 550 Sender verification failed
27530 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27531 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27532 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27533 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27536 verify = sender/no_details
27539 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27540 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27541 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27542 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27543 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27544 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27545 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27548 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27549 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27550 verification also fails.
27552 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27553 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27556 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27557 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27558 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27561 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27563 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27564 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27565 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27566 verification to succeed.
27568 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27569 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27570 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27571 option. For example:
27573 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27575 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27576 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27578 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27579 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27580 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27581 address and a report is output for each of them.
27585 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27586 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27587 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27588 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27589 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27590 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27591 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27595 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27596 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27597 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27598 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27599 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27600 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27602 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27603 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27604 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27605 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27608 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27610 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27612 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27613 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27615 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27616 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27619 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27620 use for the DNS query. The default is:
27622 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27624 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27625 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27626 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27627 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27630 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27632 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27633 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27634 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27636 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27637 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27638 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27639 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27640 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27641 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27642 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27643 of legitimate HELO domains.
27645 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27646 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27647 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27648 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27651 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27653 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27654 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27655 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27660 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27661 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
27662 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27663 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27664 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
27665 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
27666 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
27667 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
27669 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
27670 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
27671 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
27672 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
27673 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
27674 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
27675 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
27677 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
27678 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
27681 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
27682 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
27685 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
27686 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
27689 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
27690 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
27692 recipients = +batv_senders
27694 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
27695 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
27697 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
27698 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
27699 !condition = $prvscheck_result
27701 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
27702 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
27703 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
27704 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
27705 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
27707 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
27708 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
27709 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
27710 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
27711 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
27712 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
27713 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
27715 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
27716 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
27717 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
27718 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
27722 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
27724 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
27725 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
27726 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
27729 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
27732 external_smtp_batv:
27734 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
27735 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
27736 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
27737 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
27740 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
27744 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
27745 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
27746 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
27747 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
27748 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
27749 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
27750 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
27751 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
27752 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
27753 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
27755 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
27756 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
27757 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
27758 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
27759 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
27760 same host is fulfilling both functions,
27762 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
27764 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
27765 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
27766 system to arbitrary domains.
27769 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
27770 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
27771 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
27772 example, suppose you want to do the following:
27775 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
27776 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
27777 &'my.dom2.example'&.
27779 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
27780 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
27782 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
27783 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
27787 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
27789 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
27790 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
27791 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
27793 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
27797 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
27798 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
27800 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
27801 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
27802 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
27803 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
27804 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
27805 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
27806 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27810 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
27811 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
27812 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
27813 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
27814 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27816 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
27817 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
27818 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
27819 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
27820 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
27821 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
27822 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
27827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27828 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27830 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
27831 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
27832 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
27833 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
27834 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
27835 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
27838 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
27839 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
27840 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
27841 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
27842 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
27844 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
27845 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
27846 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
27849 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
27850 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
27852 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
27853 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
27854 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
27856 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
27857 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
27859 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
27862 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
27865 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
27866 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
27867 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
27869 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
27870 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
27871 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
27872 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
27873 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
27874 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
27876 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
27877 temporarily created in a file called:
27879 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
27881 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
27882 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
27883 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
27884 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
27885 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
27887 control = no_mbox_unspool
27889 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
27890 same directory by default.
27894 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
27895 .cindex "virus scanning"
27896 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
27897 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
27898 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
27899 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
27900 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
27901 in memory and thus are much faster.
27903 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
27904 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
27905 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
27906 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
27908 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
27910 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
27912 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
27914 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
27915 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
27918 .vitem &%aveserver%&
27919 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27920 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
27921 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
27922 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
27925 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
27929 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
27930 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
27931 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
27932 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
27933 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
27934 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
27935 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
27937 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
27938 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
27939 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
27941 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
27942 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
27943 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
27944 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
27945 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
27946 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
27947 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
27948 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
27949 contributing the code for this scanner.
27952 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
27953 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
27954 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
27955 type takes 3 mandatory options:
27958 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
27959 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
27962 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
27963 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
27964 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
27965 the &"trigger"& expression.
27968 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
27969 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
27970 &"name"& expression.
27973 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
27975 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
27977 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
27978 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
27979 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
27980 configuration setting:
27982 av_scanner = cmdline:\
27983 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
27984 found in file:'(.+)'
27987 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
27988 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
27989 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
27990 separated by white space, as in these examples:
27992 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
27993 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
27995 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
27996 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
27999 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
28000 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
28001 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
28003 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
28005 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
28006 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
28008 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
28009 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28010 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
28011 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
28012 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
28015 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
28017 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
28020 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
28021 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
28022 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
28023 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
28024 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
28025 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
28026 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
28028 av_scanner = mksd:2
28030 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
28033 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
28034 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
28035 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
28036 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
28037 client communication. For example:
28039 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
28041 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
28045 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
28046 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
28049 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
28050 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
28051 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
28052 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
28053 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
28054 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
28057 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
28058 use. It can then be one of
28061 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
28062 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
28065 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
28066 the condition fails immediately.
28068 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
28069 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
28070 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
28073 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
28074 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
28075 causes the ACL to defer.
28077 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
28078 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
28079 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
28080 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
28083 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
28084 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
28085 &%malware%& condition.
28087 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
28088 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
28090 Here is a very simple scanning example:
28092 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28096 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
28098 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28100 malware = */defer_ok
28102 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
28103 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
28105 av_scanner = $acl_m0
28107 in the main Exim configuration.
28109 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28110 set acl_m0 = sophie
28113 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28114 set acl_m0 = aveserver
28119 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
28120 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
28121 .cindex "spam scanning"
28122 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
28123 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
28124 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
28125 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
28126 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
28128 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
28130 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
28131 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
28134 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
28135 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
28136 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
28137 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
28138 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28140 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28142 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28143 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28144 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28147 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28149 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28150 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28151 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28152 option, separated with colons:
28154 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28155 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28158 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28159 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28160 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28163 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28164 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28166 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28167 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28168 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28171 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28172 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28174 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28177 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28178 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28179 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28180 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28181 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28183 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28184 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28185 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28186 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28187 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28190 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28191 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28192 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28195 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28196 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28197 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28200 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28201 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28205 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28206 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28207 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28208 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28210 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28211 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28212 variables. With the exception of &$spam_score_int$&, these are usable only
28213 within ACLs; their values are not retained with the message and so cannot be
28214 used at delivery time.
28217 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28218 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28219 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28221 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28222 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28223 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
28224 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
28225 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in
28226 conditions. This variable is special; its value is saved with the message, and
28227 written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used during the whole
28228 life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in routers or
28229 transports during the later delivery phase.
28231 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28232 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28233 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28234 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28235 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28237 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28238 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28239 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28242 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28243 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28244 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28246 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28247 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28248 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28249 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28250 spam condition, like this:
28252 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28253 spam = joe/defer_ok
28255 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28257 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28260 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28261 warn spam = nobody:true
28262 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28263 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28265 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28266 # is over threshold
28268 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28270 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28271 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28273 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28278 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28279 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28280 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28281 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28282 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28283 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28284 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28285 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28286 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28287 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28290 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28291 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28292 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28293 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
28294 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28295 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28296 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28298 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28299 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28300 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28301 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28302 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28304 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28305 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28306 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28307 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28308 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28311 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28313 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28317 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28319 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28320 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28321 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28322 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28324 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28325 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28326 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28327 the full path and file name.
28329 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28330 filename, and the default path is then used.
28332 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28333 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28334 a file with its original, proposed filename using
28336 decode = $mime_filename
28338 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28339 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28340 automatically unlinked.
28342 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28343 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28344 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28345 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28346 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28348 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28349 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28350 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28352 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28353 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28354 available in the MIME ACL:
28357 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28358 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28359 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28360 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28361 contains the empty string.
28363 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
28364 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28365 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28371 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28372 case-insensitively.
28374 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28375 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28376 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28377 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28378 only used for display purposes.
28380 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28381 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28382 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28384 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28385 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28386 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28388 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28389 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28390 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28391 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28392 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28394 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28395 This variable contains the normalized content of the
28396 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28397 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28399 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28400 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28401 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28402 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28406 application/octet-stream
28410 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28413 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28414 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28415 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28416 containing the decoded data.
28421 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
28422 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28423 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28424 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28425 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28426 found, this variable contains the empty string.
28428 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28429 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28430 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28431 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28433 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28434 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28438 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28441 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28442 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28445 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28446 and the rest are attachments.
28449 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28452 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28453 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28454 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28456 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28457 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28458 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28459 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28461 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28462 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28463 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28464 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28465 want to carry out specific actions on them.
28467 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28468 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28469 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28470 decoding is fully recursive.
28472 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28473 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28474 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28475 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28476 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28477 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28478 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28483 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28484 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28485 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28486 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28487 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28489 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28490 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28491 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28492 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28493 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28495 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28496 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28497 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28498 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28499 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
28500 32K characters are checked.
28502 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28503 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28504 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28505 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28506 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28508 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28509 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28511 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28512 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28513 matching regular expression.
28515 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28521 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28522 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28523 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28524 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28525 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28526 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28527 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28528 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28529 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28530 use the &%demime%& condition.
28532 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28533 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28534 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28535 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28536 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28537 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28539 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28540 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28543 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28544 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28546 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28547 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28548 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28549 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28551 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28552 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28553 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28555 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28558 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28559 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28560 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28561 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28562 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28563 zero, no error occurred.
28565 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
28566 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28567 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28568 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28572 .vitem &$found_extension$&
28573 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28574 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28575 extension it found.
28578 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28579 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28581 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28582 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28583 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28586 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28587 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28589 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28591 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28592 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28593 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28594 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28596 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28597 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
28598 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28610 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28611 "Local scan function"
28612 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28613 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28614 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28615 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28616 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28618 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28619 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28620 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28621 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28622 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28624 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28625 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28626 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28627 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28629 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28630 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28631 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28632 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28634 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28635 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28636 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28637 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28638 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28639 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28640 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28641 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28642 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28646 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28647 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28648 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28649 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28650 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28651 directory, so you might set
28653 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28655 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28656 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28657 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28658 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28659 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28660 _src/local_scan.c_.
28662 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28663 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28665 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28667 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
28672 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
28673 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
28674 You must include this line near the start of your code:
28676 #include "local_scan.h"
28678 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
28679 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
28680 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
28681 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
28682 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
28683 strings and pointers to character strings:
28685 #define CS (char *)
28686 #define CCS (const char *)
28687 #define CSS (char **)
28688 #define US (unsigned char *)
28689 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
28690 #define USS (unsigned char **)
28692 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
28694 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
28696 The arguments are as follows:
28699 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
28700 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
28701 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
28703 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
28704 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
28705 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
28706 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
28707 case this changes in some future version.
28709 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
28710 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
28713 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
28716 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
28717 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
28718 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
28719 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
28720 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
28721 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
28723 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
28724 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28725 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
28727 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
28728 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28729 queued without immediate delivery.
28731 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
28732 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
28733 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
28734 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
28735 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
28738 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
28739 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
28740 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
28743 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28744 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
28745 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
28746 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
28747 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
28748 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
28749 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28751 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28752 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
28753 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28756 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
28757 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
28758 &%-oe%& command line options.
28762 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
28763 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
28764 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
28765 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
28766 want to do this, you must have the line
28768 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28770 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
28771 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
28772 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
28775 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
28776 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
28777 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
28778 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
28779 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
28780 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
28782 static int my_integer_option = 42;
28783 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
28785 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
28786 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
28787 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
28790 int local_scan_options_count =
28791 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
28793 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
28794 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
28798 my_string = some string of text...
28800 The available types of option data are as follows:
28803 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
28804 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
28805 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
28806 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
28807 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
28808 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
28811 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
28812 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
28813 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
28814 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
28817 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
28818 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
28821 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
28822 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
28823 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
28824 printed with the suffix K or M.
28826 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
28827 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
28828 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
28829 always output in octal.
28831 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
28832 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
28833 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
28835 .vitem &*opt_time*&
28836 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
28837 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
28840 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
28841 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
28845 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
28846 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
28847 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
28848 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
28849 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
28850 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
28851 C variables are as follows:
28854 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
28855 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
28857 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
28858 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
28860 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
28861 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
28862 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
28863 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
28866 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
28867 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
28868 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
28871 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
28872 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
28876 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
28877 selected, you should use code like this:
28879 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28880 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28882 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
28883 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
28884 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
28886 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
28887 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
28890 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
28891 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
28893 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
28894 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
28896 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
28897 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
28898 &%-bh%& command line option.
28900 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
28901 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
28902 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
28904 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
28905 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
28906 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
28907 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
28909 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
28910 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
28911 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
28913 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
28914 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
28916 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
28917 The number of accepted recipients.
28919 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
28920 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
28921 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
28922 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
28923 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
28924 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
28925 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
28926 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
28927 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
28928 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
28929 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
28930 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
28932 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
28933 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
28935 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
28936 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
28937 locally-submitted messages.
28939 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
28940 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
28941 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
28943 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
28944 The name of the sending host, if known.
28946 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
28947 The port on the sending host.
28949 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
28950 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
28952 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
28953 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
28955 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
28956 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
28957 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
28961 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
28962 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
28963 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
28964 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
28969 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
28970 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
28972 .vitem &*int&~type*&
28973 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
28974 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
28975 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
28976 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
28977 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
28978 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
28980 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
28981 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
28984 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
28985 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
28986 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
28991 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
28992 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
28995 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
28996 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
28998 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
28999 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
29000 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
29001 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
29003 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
29004 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
29005 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
29006 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
29007 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
29008 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
29009 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
29010 is NULL for all recipients.
29015 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
29016 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
29017 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
29018 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
29022 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
29023 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
29025 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
29026 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
29027 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
29028 for the process in &%newumask%&.
29030 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
29031 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
29032 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
29033 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
29034 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
29036 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
29038 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
29039 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
29040 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
29041 return value is as follows:
29046 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
29052 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
29058 The process timed out.
29062 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
29065 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
29066 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
29067 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
29068 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
29069 forks a subprocess that is running
29071 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
29073 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
29074 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
29075 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
29076 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
29078 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
29079 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
29080 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
29081 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
29084 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
29085 *sender_authentication)*&
29086 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
29089 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
29091 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
29094 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29095 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
29096 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
29097 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
29098 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
29100 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29101 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29104 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
29105 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
29106 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
29107 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
29108 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
29109 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
29110 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
29111 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
29113 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
29114 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
29115 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
29116 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
29117 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29118 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29120 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29121 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
29122 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
29123 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
29125 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
29126 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
29127 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
29128 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
29129 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
29130 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
29131 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
29132 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
29133 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
29134 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
29136 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
29137 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
29139 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29140 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29143 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29144 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29145 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29146 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29147 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29150 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29151 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29152 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29153 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29154 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29155 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29157 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29159 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29160 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29161 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29162 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29163 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29166 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29167 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29168 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29169 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29170 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29171 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29172 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29173 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29175 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29176 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29177 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29179 &`OK `& match succeeded
29180 &`FAIL `& match failed
29181 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29183 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29184 inability to contact a database.
29186 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29188 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29189 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29190 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29192 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29194 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29195 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29196 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29198 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29200 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29203 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29205 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29206 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29207 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29208 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29209 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29210 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29213 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29215 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29216 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29217 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29218 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29219 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29220 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29223 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29224 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29225 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29226 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29228 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29229 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29230 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29231 value afterwards. For example:
29233 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29234 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29235 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29238 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29239 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29240 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29241 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29248 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29249 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29250 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29251 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29252 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29253 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29254 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29255 binary string is returned with an error message.
29257 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29258 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29259 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29261 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29262 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29263 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29264 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29265 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29267 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29268 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29269 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29271 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29272 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29273 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29274 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29278 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29279 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29282 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29283 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29284 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29285 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29286 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29287 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29288 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29289 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29292 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29293 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29295 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29296 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29297 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29298 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29299 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29300 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29301 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29303 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29304 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29306 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29307 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29308 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29309 multiple output lines.
29311 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29312 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29313 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29314 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29315 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29316 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29317 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29320 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29321 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29322 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29323 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29325 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29326 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29327 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29329 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29332 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29335 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29336 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29337 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29338 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29339 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29340 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29346 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29347 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29348 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29349 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29350 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29351 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29352 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29355 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29356 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29357 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29358 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29360 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29361 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29363 store_pool = POOL_PERM
29365 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29366 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29367 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29368 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29370 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29371 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29372 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29373 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29380 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29383 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29384 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29385 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29386 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29387 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29388 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29389 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29390 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29392 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29393 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29394 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29395 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29396 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29398 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29399 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29400 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29401 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29402 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29403 prevent it happening on retries.
29405 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29406 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29407 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29408 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29409 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29410 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29411 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29412 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29415 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29416 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29417 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29418 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29419 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29420 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29421 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29423 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29424 system_filter_user = exim
29426 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29427 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29428 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29429 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29430 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29431 by the &%reply%& command.
29434 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29435 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29436 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29437 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29439 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29440 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29444 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29445 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29446 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29447 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29448 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29449 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29452 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29453 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29454 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29455 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29456 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29457 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29458 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29460 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29461 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29462 succeed, it will not be tried again.
29463 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29464 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29466 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29467 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29468 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29469 to which users' filter files can refer.
29473 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29474 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
29475 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29476 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29477 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29481 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29482 .cindex "freezing messages"
29483 .cindex "message" "freezing"
29484 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
29485 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29486 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29487 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29488 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29489 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29490 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29491 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29492 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29494 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29496 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29498 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29499 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29500 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29501 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29502 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29505 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29506 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29507 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29508 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29510 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29511 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29512 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29513 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29514 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29515 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29516 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29517 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29518 message. For example:
29520 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29521 because it contains attachments that we are \
29522 not prepared to receive."
29525 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29526 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29527 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29528 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29529 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29530 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29533 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29534 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29536 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29537 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29538 generated by the filter.
29540 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29542 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29543 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29549 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29550 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29555 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29556 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29557 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29558 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29559 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29561 headers add <string>
29562 headers remove <string>
29564 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29565 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29566 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29567 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29568 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29570 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29571 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29572 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29575 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29576 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29579 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29580 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29581 space after input continuations is ignored.
29583 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29584 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29585 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29586 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29587 header with the same name, they are all removed.
29589 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29590 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29591 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29592 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29593 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29594 used for all recipients of the message.
29596 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29597 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29598 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29599 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29600 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29601 until the message is actually being written (see section
29602 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29604 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29605 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29606 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29607 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29608 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29609 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29610 modified more than once.
29612 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29613 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29616 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29617 headers remove "Subject"
29618 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29619 headers remove "Old-Subject"
29624 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29625 .cindex "envelope sender"
29626 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29628 errors_to <some address>
29630 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29631 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29632 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29635 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29637 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29638 address if its delivery failed.
29642 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29643 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29644 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29645 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29646 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29647 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29648 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29649 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29650 which implements such a filter:
29655 domains = +local_domains
29656 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29661 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29662 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29663 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29664 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29666 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29667 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
29668 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
29669 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
29671 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
29672 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
29673 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
29680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29683 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
29684 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
29685 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
29686 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
29687 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
29688 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
29689 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
29690 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
29692 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
29693 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
29694 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
29695 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
29696 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
29698 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
29699 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
29700 loopback interface specially in any way.
29702 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
29703 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
29708 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
29709 .cindex "message" "submission"
29710 .cindex "submission mode"
29711 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
29712 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
29713 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
29714 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
29716 control = submission
29718 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
29719 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
29720 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
29721 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
29722 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
29723 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
29725 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
29726 control = submission
29728 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
29729 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
29730 is used to separate options. For example:
29732 control = submission/sender_retain
29734 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
29735 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
29736 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
29737 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
29738 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
29739 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
29740 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
29742 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
29743 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
29746 control = submission/domain=some.domain
29748 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
29749 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
29750 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
29751 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
29753 accept authenticated = *
29754 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
29755 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
29756 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
29758 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
29759 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
29760 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
29762 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
29764 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
29767 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
29769 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
29770 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
29771 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
29772 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
29774 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
29775 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
29776 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
29777 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
29778 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
29779 spoof another's address.
29781 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
29782 .cindex "line endings"
29783 .cindex "carriage return"
29785 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
29786 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
29787 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
29788 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
29789 use CRLF or just CR.
29791 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
29792 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
29793 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
29794 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
29795 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
29796 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
29797 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
29798 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
29802 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
29804 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
29807 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
29808 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
29811 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
29812 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
29813 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
29814 people trying to play silly games.
29816 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
29817 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
29825 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
29826 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
29827 .cindex "address" "qualification"
29828 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
29829 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
29830 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
29831 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
29832 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
29834 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
29835 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
29836 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
29837 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
29838 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
29840 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
29841 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
29842 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
29843 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
29844 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
29845 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
29846 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
29847 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
29852 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
29853 .cindex "&""From""& line"
29854 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
29855 .cindex "sender" "address"
29856 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
29857 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
29858 .cindex "envelope sender"
29859 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29860 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
29861 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
29862 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
29864 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
29865 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
29867 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
29868 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
29869 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
29870 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
29871 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
29872 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
29873 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
29874 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
29875 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
29877 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
29878 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
29879 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
29880 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
29881 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
29882 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
29883 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
29885 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
29886 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
29887 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
29889 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
29890 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
29891 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
29892 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
29896 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
29897 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
29898 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
29899 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
29900 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
29901 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
29902 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
29905 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
29906 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
29909 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
29910 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
29914 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
29915 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
29917 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
29918 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
29919 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
29921 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
29924 For a locally-submitted message,
29925 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
29926 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
29927 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
29928 included in log lines in this case.
29930 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
29931 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
29937 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
29938 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
29939 includes the header line:
29941 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
29944 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
29945 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
29946 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
29947 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
29948 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
29949 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
29952 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
29953 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
29954 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
29955 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
29956 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
29958 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
29959 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
29960 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
29961 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
29962 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
29963 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
29964 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
29965 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
29969 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
29970 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
29971 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
29972 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
29973 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
29974 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
29975 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
29976 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
29980 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
29981 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
29982 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29983 .cindex "message" "submission"
29984 .cindex "submission mode"
29985 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
29986 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
29989 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
29990 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
29992 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29993 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
29995 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29996 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29997 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
29999 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
30000 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30002 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30003 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30007 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
30009 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
30010 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
30011 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
30012 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30013 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
30014 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
30015 &%qualify_domain%&.
30017 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
30018 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
30019 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
30020 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30023 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
30024 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
30025 .cindex "message" "submission"
30026 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
30027 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
30028 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
30029 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
30030 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
30031 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
30032 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
30033 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
30034 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
30035 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
30038 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
30039 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
30040 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
30041 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
30042 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
30044 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
30045 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
30046 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
30047 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
30049 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
30050 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
30051 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
30054 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
30055 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
30056 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
30057 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
30058 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
30059 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
30060 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
30061 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
30062 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
30063 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
30064 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
30068 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
30069 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
30070 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
30071 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
30072 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
30073 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
30074 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
30075 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
30079 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
30080 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
30081 .cindex "message" "submission"
30082 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
30083 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
30084 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
30085 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30088 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
30089 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30090 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
30091 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
30092 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
30093 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
30094 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
30095 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
30096 line is added to the message.
30098 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
30099 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
30100 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
30101 options true at the same time.
30103 .cindex "submission mode"
30104 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
30105 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
30106 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
30107 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
30109 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30110 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
30111 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
30112 created as follows:
30115 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30116 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30117 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30119 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
30120 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30122 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30123 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30126 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
30127 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
30128 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
30129 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
30131 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
30132 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
30133 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
30134 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
30138 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30139 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30140 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30141 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30142 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30143 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30144 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30145 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30146 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30148 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30149 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30150 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30151 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30152 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30153 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30155 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30156 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30157 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30159 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30160 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30161 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30163 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30164 X-added-second: another added header line
30166 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30168 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30169 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30170 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30171 not part of the names. For example:
30173 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30175 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30176 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30177 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30178 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30179 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30181 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30182 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30183 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30184 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30186 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30187 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30188 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30191 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30192 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30193 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30194 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30195 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30196 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30197 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30199 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30200 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30201 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30202 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30204 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30205 the following consequences:
30208 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30209 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30210 to it, at all times.
30212 Header lines that are added by a router's
30213 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30214 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30216 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30217 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30219 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30220 a later router or by a transport.
30222 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30223 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30225 headers_remove = subject
30226 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30230 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30231 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30237 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30238 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30239 .cindex "constructed address"
30240 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30243 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30247 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30249 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30250 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30251 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30252 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30253 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30254 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30255 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30256 there is no password file entry.
30259 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30260 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30261 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30262 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30263 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30264 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30265 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30266 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30270 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30271 .cindex "case of local parts"
30272 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30273 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30274 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30275 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30276 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30277 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30278 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30281 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30282 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30283 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30284 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30285 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30289 domains = +local_domains
30290 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30291 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30294 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30295 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30296 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30297 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30298 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30302 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30303 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
30304 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
30305 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30306 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30307 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30308 empty components for compatibility.
30312 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30313 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30314 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30315 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30316 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30317 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30319 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30320 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30321 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30322 example, a header such as
30326 might get rewritten as
30328 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30330 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30331 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30334 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30335 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30336 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30337 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30338 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30339 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30340 .ecindex IIDmesproc
30344 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30345 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30347 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30348 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30349 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30350 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30351 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30352 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30353 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30356 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30358 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30360 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30363 For mail delivery, the following are available:
30366 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30368 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30371 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30374 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30375 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30378 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30379 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30380 used to contain the envelope information.
30384 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30385 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30386 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30387 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30388 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30391 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30392 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30393 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30394 processing is the same in both cases.
30396 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30397 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30398 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30399 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30400 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30401 .cindex "transport" "filter"
30402 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30403 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30406 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30407 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30408 required for the transaction.
30410 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30411 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30412 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30414 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30415 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30416 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30418 .cindex "carriage return"
30420 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30421 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30422 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30425 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30426 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30427 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30428 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30429 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30430 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
30431 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30432 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30433 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30435 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30436 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30437 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30438 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30440 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30441 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30442 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30443 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30445 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30446 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30447 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30448 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30449 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30450 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30451 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30452 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30453 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30454 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30456 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30457 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30459 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30460 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30461 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30462 square bracket of the IP address.
30467 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30468 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30469 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30470 .cindex "host" "error"
30471 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30472 message errors, and recipient errors.
30475 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30476 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30477 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30480 Connection refused or timed out,
30482 Any error response code on connection,
30484 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30486 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30488 I/O errors at any time,
30490 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30491 the &"."& at the end of the data.
30494 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30495 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30496 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30497 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30498 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30499 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30500 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30501 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30503 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30504 .cindex "message" "error"
30505 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30506 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30507 message errors are:
30510 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30513 Timeout after MAIL,
30515 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30516 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30517 connection at any other time.
30520 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30521 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30522 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30523 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30524 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30525 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30526 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30527 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30528 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30529 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30531 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30532 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30533 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30536 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30537 .cindex "recipient" "error"
30538 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30539 recipient errors are:
30542 Any error response to RCPT,
30544 Timeout after RCPT.
30547 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30548 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30549 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30550 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30551 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30552 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30553 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30554 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30555 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30556 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30557 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30558 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30559 the retry clock is reset.
30561 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30562 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30563 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30564 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30565 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30566 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30567 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30568 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30569 recipient's retry time.
30572 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30573 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30574 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30575 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30576 until the next delivery attempt.
30578 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30579 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30580 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30581 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30582 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30585 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30586 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30587 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30588 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30589 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30590 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30591 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30593 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30594 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30595 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30596 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30597 then to be treated as a host error.
30599 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30600 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30601 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30602 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30603 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30608 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30609 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30610 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30613 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30614 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30615 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30617 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30619 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30620 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30621 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30622 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30623 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30624 stream and exits with an error code.
30626 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30627 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30628 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30629 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30631 .cindex "carriage return"
30633 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30634 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30635 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30637 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30638 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30639 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30641 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30642 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30643 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30644 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30645 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30646 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30647 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30648 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30650 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30651 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30652 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30653 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30654 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30655 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30656 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30657 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30658 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30660 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30661 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30662 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30664 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30665 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30666 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30667 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
30668 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
30670 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
30671 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
30672 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
30673 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
30674 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
30675 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
30676 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
30678 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
30679 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
30680 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
30681 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
30682 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
30684 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
30685 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
30686 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
30687 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
30688 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
30689 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
30690 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
30691 a delivery process.
30693 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
30694 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
30695 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
30696 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
30697 however, available with &'inetd'&.
30699 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
30700 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
30701 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
30702 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
30704 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
30705 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
30706 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
30710 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
30711 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
30712 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
30713 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
30714 the error response to the last command. The default value for
30715 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
30716 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
30717 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
30720 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
30721 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
30722 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
30723 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
30724 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
30725 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
30726 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
30727 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
30728 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
30729 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
30730 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
30734 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
30735 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
30736 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
30737 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
30738 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
30739 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
30740 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
30741 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
30743 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
30744 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
30745 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
30746 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
30747 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
30750 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
30751 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
30752 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
30754 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
30755 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
30756 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
30757 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
30758 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
30763 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
30764 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
30765 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
30766 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
30767 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30769 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
30770 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
30771 called with the &%-bv%& option.
30773 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
30774 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
30775 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
30776 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
30777 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
30778 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
30779 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
30784 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
30785 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
30786 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
30787 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
30788 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
30789 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
30790 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30792 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
30793 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
30794 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
30795 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
30796 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
30797 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
30798 argument. For example,
30806 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
30807 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
30808 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
30809 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
30810 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
30812 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
30813 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
30814 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
30815 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
30816 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
30817 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
30818 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
30819 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
30821 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
30822 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
30823 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
30824 whatever the form of its argument. For
30827 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
30828 $sender_host_address
30830 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30831 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
30832 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
30833 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
30834 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
30835 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
30836 for it to change them before running the command.
30840 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
30841 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
30842 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
30843 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
30844 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
30845 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
30846 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
30847 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
30848 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
30849 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
30850 runs for RCPT commands:
30854 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
30858 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
30859 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
30860 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
30861 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
30862 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
30863 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
30864 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
30865 envelope along with the message.
30867 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
30868 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
30869 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
30870 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
30871 can be used to specify it.
30873 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
30874 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
30875 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
30876 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
30877 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
30880 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
30881 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
30882 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
30887 driver = manualroute
30888 transport = smtp_appendfile
30889 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
30893 driver = appendfile
30894 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
30899 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
30900 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
30901 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
30905 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
30906 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
30907 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
30908 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
30909 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
30910 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
30911 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
30912 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
30913 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
30914 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
30916 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
30917 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
30919 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
30920 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
30921 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
30922 make some use of automatically, for example:
30924 554 Unexpected end of file
30925 Transaction started in line 10
30926 Error detected in line 14
30928 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
30931 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
30932 The error message was:
30934 501 '>' missing at end of address
30936 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
30937 The error was detected in line 12.
30938 The SMTP command at fault was:
30940 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
30942 1 previous message was successfully processed.
30943 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
30945 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
30946 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
30948 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
30949 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
30953 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30954 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30956 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
30957 "Customizing messages"
30958 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
30959 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
30960 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
30961 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
30962 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
30964 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
30965 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
30966 option. Exim also adds the line
30968 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
30970 to all warning and bounce messages,
30973 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
30974 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
30975 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
30976 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
30977 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
30978 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
30979 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
30981 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
30982 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
30983 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
30984 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
30985 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
30988 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
30989 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
30990 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
30991 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
30992 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
30993 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
30994 option, rounded to a whole number.
30996 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
30999 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31000 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31002 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
31003 failing addresses with their error messages.
31005 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
31006 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
31008 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
31009 as part of the error report.
31011 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
31012 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
31014 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
31017 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
31018 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
31019 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
31021 Subject: Mail delivery failed
31022 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31023 {: returning message to sender}}
31025 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31027 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31028 {that you sent }{sent by
31032 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
31033 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
31035 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
31037 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
31040 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
31042 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
31045 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
31046 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
31047 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
31048 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
31049 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
31053 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31054 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31056 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
31057 the delayed addresses.
31059 The third item then ends the message.
31062 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
31063 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
31065 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
31066 $warn_message_delay
31068 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31070 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
31071 {that you sent }{sent by
31075 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
31076 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
31078 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
31079 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
31080 The date of the message is: $h_date
31082 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
31084 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
31085 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
31086 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
31087 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
31088 the message will be returned to you.
31090 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
31091 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
31092 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
31093 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
31094 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
31095 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
31096 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
31097 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
31103 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31104 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31106 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
31107 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
31108 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
31112 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
31113 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
31114 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
31115 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
31116 routing explicitly:
31118 send_to_smart_host:
31119 driver = manualroute
31120 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
31121 transport = remote_smtp
31123 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
31124 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
31125 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
31126 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
31127 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
31132 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
31133 .cindex "mailing lists"
31134 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
31135 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
31136 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
31138 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31139 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31140 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31141 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31145 domains = lists.example
31146 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31149 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31152 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31153 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31154 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31155 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31157 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31158 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31161 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31162 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31163 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31164 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31165 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31167 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31168 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31169 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31170 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31171 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31172 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31173 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31174 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31175 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31179 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31180 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31181 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31182 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31183 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31184 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31185 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31187 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31188 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31189 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31190 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31191 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31195 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31196 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31197 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31198 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31199 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31200 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31201 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31202 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31203 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31204 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31206 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31207 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31208 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31209 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31210 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31211 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31212 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31213 pre-existing messages.
31215 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31216 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31217 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31218 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31219 one level of expansion anyway.
31223 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31224 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31225 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31226 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31227 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31228 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31230 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31231 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31235 domains = lists.example
31236 local_part_suffix = -request
31237 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31242 domains = lists.example
31243 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31244 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31245 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31248 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31253 domains = lists.example
31255 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31257 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31258 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31259 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31262 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31263 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31264 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31265 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31266 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31267 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31268 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31269 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31270 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31272 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31273 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31274 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31279 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31281 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31282 .cindex "envelope sender"
31283 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31284 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31285 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31286 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31287 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31288 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31290 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31291 .oindex &%return_path%&
31292 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31293 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31294 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31295 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31296 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31297 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31298 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31304 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31305 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31307 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31308 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31309 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31310 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31311 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31312 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31313 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31316 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31318 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31319 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31320 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31321 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31322 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31323 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31325 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31326 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31327 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31328 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31332 domains = ! +local_domains
31334 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31335 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31338 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31339 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31340 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31341 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31344 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31345 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31346 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31347 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31348 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31352 domains = ! +local_domains
31353 transport = remote_smtp
31355 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31356 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31359 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31360 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31361 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31362 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31365 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31366 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31367 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31368 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31369 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31370 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31378 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31379 .cindex "virtual domains"
31380 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
31381 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31385 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31386 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31387 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31389 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31390 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31391 have login accounts on that host.
31394 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31395 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31396 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31397 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31398 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31399 to a router of this form:
31403 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31404 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31407 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31408 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31409 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31410 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31411 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31412 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31414 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31415 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31416 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31417 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31419 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31420 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31421 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31425 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31426 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31427 transport = my_mailboxes
31429 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31430 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31431 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31432 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31433 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31437 driver = appendfile
31438 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31441 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31442 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31444 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31445 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31446 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31447 information about the domains.
31451 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31452 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31453 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31454 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
31455 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
31456 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31457 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31458 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31459 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31460 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31461 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31462 example, consider this router:
31467 file = $home/.forward
31468 local_part_suffix = -*
31469 local_part_suffix_optional
31472 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31473 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31474 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31475 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31477 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31478 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31481 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31482 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31483 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31484 control over which suffixes are valid.
31486 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31487 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31493 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31494 local_part_suffix = -*
31495 local_part_suffix_optional
31498 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31499 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31500 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31501 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31502 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31506 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31507 .cindex "vacation processing"
31508 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31509 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31510 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31511 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31512 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31515 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31516 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31517 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31518 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31520 spqr, vacation-spqr
31523 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31524 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31525 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31526 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31527 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31531 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31532 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31536 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31537 .cindex "message" "copying every"
31538 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31539 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31540 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31541 each day's messages.
31543 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31544 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31545 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31546 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31550 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31551 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31552 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31553 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31554 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31555 permanently connected.
31557 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31558 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31559 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31562 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31563 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31564 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31565 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31566 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31567 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31568 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31569 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31571 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31572 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31573 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31574 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31575 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31576 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31579 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31580 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31581 intermittent host. For example:
31583 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31585 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31586 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31587 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31588 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31589 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31590 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31593 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31594 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31595 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31596 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31597 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31598 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31599 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31603 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31604 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31605 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31606 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31607 delivered immediately.
31609 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31610 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31611 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31612 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31613 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31614 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31615 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31616 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31617 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31618 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31619 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31620 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31621 single SMTP connection.
31625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31626 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31628 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31629 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31630 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
31631 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31632 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31633 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31634 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31635 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31636 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31637 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31640 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31641 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31642 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31643 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31644 email is not desirable.
31646 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31647 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31648 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31649 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31650 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31651 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31652 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31654 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31655 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31656 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31657 before sending a message to the smart host.
31659 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31660 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31661 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31663 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31664 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31665 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31666 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31667 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
31668 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
31669 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
31671 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
31675 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
31676 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
31678 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
31679 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
31680 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
31681 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
31682 successful, a zero return code is given.
31684 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
31685 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
31686 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
31687 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
31688 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
31691 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
31692 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
31693 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
31695 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
31696 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
31697 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
31698 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
31699 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
31701 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
31702 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
31703 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
31705 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
31706 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
31707 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
31708 are ever generated.
31710 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
31712 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
31713 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
31714 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
31717 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
31718 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
31719 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
31720 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
31721 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
31722 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
31727 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31728 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31730 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
31731 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
31732 .cindex "log" "types of"
31733 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
31738 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
31739 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
31740 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
31741 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
31742 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
31743 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
31744 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
31745 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
31747 .cindex "reject log"
31748 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
31749 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
31750 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
31751 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
31752 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
31753 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
31754 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
31755 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
31756 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
31759 .cindex "panic log"
31760 .cindex "system log"
31761 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
31762 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
31763 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
31764 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
31765 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
31766 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
31767 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
31768 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
31769 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
31772 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
31773 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
31774 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
31776 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
31779 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
31780 ways of changing this:
31783 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
31788 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
31790 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
31793 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
31797 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
31798 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
31799 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
31800 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
31801 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
31802 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
31807 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
31808 .cindex "log" "destination"
31809 .cindex "log" "to file"
31810 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
31812 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
31813 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
31814 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
31815 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
31816 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
31817 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
31818 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
31820 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
31821 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
31822 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
31823 references to the host name:
31825 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
31827 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
31828 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
31829 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
31830 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
31831 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
31834 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
31835 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
31836 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
31837 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
31838 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
31839 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
31840 implying the use of a default path.
31842 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
31843 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
31844 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
31845 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
31846 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
31847 equivalent to the setting:
31849 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
31851 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
31854 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& if datestamped log file names are in
31855 use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
31857 Here are some examples of possible settings:
31859 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
31860 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
31861 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
31862 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
31864 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
31869 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
31870 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
31871 .cindex "cycling logs"
31872 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
31873 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
31874 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
31875 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
31876 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
31877 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
31878 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
31880 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
31881 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
31882 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
31883 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
31884 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
31885 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
31886 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
31887 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
31888 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
31889 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
31890 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
31895 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
31896 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
31897 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
31898 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
31899 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_&.
31900 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
31901 &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& at the point where the
31902 datestamp is required. For example:
31904 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
31905 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
31906 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
31908 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
31909 examples of names generated by the above examples:
31911 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
31912 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
31913 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
31915 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
31916 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
31917 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
31918 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
31920 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
31921 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
31922 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& is removed from the string.
31923 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
31924 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
31925 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
31927 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31928 /var/log/exim-panic.log
31929 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31933 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
31934 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
31935 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
31936 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
31937 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
31938 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
31939 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
31940 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
31941 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
31942 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
31943 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
31944 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
31945 the time and host name to each line.
31946 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
31949 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
31951 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
31953 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
31956 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
31957 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
31958 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
31959 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
31961 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
31962 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
31963 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
31964 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
31965 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
31966 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
31967 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
31968 RFC 3164, you should set
31970 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
31972 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
31973 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
31975 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
31976 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
31977 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
31978 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
31979 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
31980 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
31981 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
31982 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
31983 name, and pid as added by syslog:
31985 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
31986 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
31987 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
31988 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
31991 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
31994 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
31995 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
31996 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
31997 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
31999 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
32000 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
32001 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
32002 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
32003 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
32004 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
32006 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
32007 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
32008 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
32011 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
32013 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
32014 without modification.
32016 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
32017 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
32018 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
32023 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
32024 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
32025 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
32026 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
32027 timestamp. The flags are:
32029 &`<=`& message arrival
32030 &`=>`& normal message delivery
32031 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
32032 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
32033 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
32034 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
32038 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
32039 .cindex "log" "reception line"
32040 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32041 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
32042 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
32044 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
32045 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
32046 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
32048 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
32049 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
32050 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
32054 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
32058 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
32059 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
32060 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
32061 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
32062 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
32063 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
32064 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
32065 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
32066 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
32067 name in parentheses.
32069 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
32070 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
32071 the log containing text like these examples:
32073 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
32074 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
32076 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
32079 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
32080 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
32083 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
32084 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
32085 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
32086 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
32087 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
32088 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
32089 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
32090 suite that was used.
32092 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
32093 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
32094 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
32095 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
32096 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
32097 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
32098 authenticator name.
32100 .cindex "size" "of message"
32101 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
32102 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
32103 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
32104 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
32107 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32108 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32112 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
32113 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
32114 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32115 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
32116 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
32117 to fit it on the page:
32119 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
32120 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
32121 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
32122 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
32123 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
32125 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
32126 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
32127 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
32128 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
32129 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
32131 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
32132 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
32134 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
32136 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
32137 parentheses afterwards.
32139 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32140 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32141 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32142 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32143 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32144 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32146 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32147 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32149 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32150 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32153 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32154 .cindex "discarded messages"
32155 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32156 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32157 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32158 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32160 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32161 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32163 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32164 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32166 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32167 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32171 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32172 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32174 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32175 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32177 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32178 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32179 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32181 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32182 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32184 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32185 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32186 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32190 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32191 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32192 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32193 following form is logged:
32195 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32196 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32198 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32199 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32201 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32202 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32203 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32204 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32205 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32207 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32208 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32209 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32210 flagged with &`**`&.
32214 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32215 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32216 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32217 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32218 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32222 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32225 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32227 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32228 at the end of its processing.
32233 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32234 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32235 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32236 the following table:
32238 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32239 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32240 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32241 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32242 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32243 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32244 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32245 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32246 &`H `& host name and IP address
32247 &`I `& local interface used
32248 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32249 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32250 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32251 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32252 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32253 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32254 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32255 &`S `& size of message
32256 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32257 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32258 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32259 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32260 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32264 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32265 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32266 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32269 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32270 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32271 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32272 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32273 during the first delivery attempt.
32275 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32276 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32277 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32279 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32280 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32281 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32282 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32283 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32286 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32287 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32290 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32291 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32293 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32294 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32296 A delivery set up by a router configured with
32297 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32298 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32302 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32310 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32311 .cindex "log" "selectors"
32312 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32313 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32314 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32317 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32319 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32320 selection marked by asterisks:
32322 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32323 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32324 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32325 &` arguments `& command line arguments
32326 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32327 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32328 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32329 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32330 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32331 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32332 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32333 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32334 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32335 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32336 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32337 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32338 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32339 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32340 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32341 &` pid `& Exim process id
32342 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32343 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32344 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32345 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32346 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32347 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32348 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32349 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32350 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32351 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32352 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32353 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32354 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32355 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32356 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32357 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32358 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32359 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32360 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32361 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32363 &` all `& all of the above
32365 More details on each of these items follows:
32368 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32369 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32370 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32371 this log selector is set.
32373 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
32374 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32375 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32376 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32377 such users cannot access the log).
32379 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
32380 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32381 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32382 parentheses between them.
32384 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32385 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32386 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32387 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32388 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32389 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32390 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32391 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32392 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32393 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32394 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32395 between the caller and Exim.
32397 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32398 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32399 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32401 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32402 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32403 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32404 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32405 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32406 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32408 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32409 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32410 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32412 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32413 .cindex "size" "of message"
32414 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32415 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32417 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32418 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32419 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32420 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32421 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32423 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32424 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32425 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32426 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32427 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32428 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32430 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32431 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32432 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32433 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32434 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32436 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32437 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32438 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32439 client's ident port times out.
32441 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32442 .cindex "interface" "logging"
32443 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32444 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32445 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32446 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32449 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32450 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
32451 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32452 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32453 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32454 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32455 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32456 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32457 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32458 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32459 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32461 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32462 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32463 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32465 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32466 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32467 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32468 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32469 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32470 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32471 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32473 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32474 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32475 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32476 immediately after the time and date.
32478 .cindex "log" "queue run"
32479 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32480 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32482 .cindex "log" "queue time"
32483 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32484 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32485 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32486 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32487 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32488 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32489 message has been successfully received.
32491 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32492 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32493 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32494 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32496 .cindex "log" "recipients"
32497 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32498 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32499 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32500 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32502 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32505 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
32506 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32507 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32508 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32510 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32511 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32512 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32513 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32514 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32516 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
32517 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32518 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32519 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32522 .cindex "log" "return path"
32523 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32524 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32525 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32526 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32528 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32529 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32530 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32531 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32532 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32534 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32535 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32536 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32537 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32540 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
32541 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32544 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32545 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32546 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32547 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32549 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32550 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32552 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32553 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32554 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32555 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32556 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32559 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32560 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32561 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32562 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32563 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32564 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32565 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32566 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32567 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32568 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32570 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32571 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32572 reset if the daemon is restarted.
32573 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32574 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32575 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32576 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32577 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32579 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32580 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32581 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32582 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32583 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32584 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32586 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32587 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32588 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32589 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32590 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32591 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32592 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32593 already have their own log lines.
32595 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32596 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32597 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32598 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32599 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32600 the same logging options.
32602 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32603 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32607 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32608 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32609 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32610 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32611 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32613 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32614 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32615 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32616 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32617 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32618 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32619 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32620 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32622 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32623 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32624 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32625 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32626 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32627 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32628 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32629 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32630 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32632 .cindex "log" "subject"
32633 .cindex "subject, logging"
32634 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32635 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32636 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32637 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32638 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32640 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32641 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32642 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32643 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32645 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32646 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32647 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32648 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32650 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32651 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32652 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32653 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32654 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32656 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32657 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32658 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32662 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
32663 .cindex "message" "log file for"
32664 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
32665 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
32666 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
32667 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
32668 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
32669 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
32670 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
32671 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
32672 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
32673 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
32674 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
32676 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
32677 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
32678 &%message_logs%& option false.
32684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32687 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
32688 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
32689 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
32690 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
32691 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
32693 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
32694 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
32695 "list what Exim processes are doing"
32696 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
32697 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
32698 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
32699 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
32701 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
32702 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
32703 "extract statistics from the log"
32704 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
32705 "check address acceptance from given IP"
32706 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
32707 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
32708 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
32709 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
32710 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
32711 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
32714 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
32715 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
32716 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
32721 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
32722 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
32723 .cindex "process, querying"
32725 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
32726 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
32727 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
32728 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
32729 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
32730 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
32731 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
32732 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
32734 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
32735 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
32736 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
32739 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
32740 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
32741 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
32742 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
32743 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
32746 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
32747 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
32748 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
32749 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
32751 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
32753 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
32754 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
32755 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
32756 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
32757 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
32758 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
32760 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
32761 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
32765 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
32766 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
32767 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
32768 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
32772 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
32773 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
32774 options are available:
32777 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
32778 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
32779 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
32783 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
32784 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
32787 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
32788 Match against the size field.
32790 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32791 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
32793 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32794 Match messages that are older than the given time.
32797 Match only frozen messages.
32800 Match only non-frozen messages.
32803 The following options control the format of the output:
32807 Display only the count of matching messages.
32810 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
32814 Display message ids only.
32817 Brief format &-- one line per message.
32820 Display messages in reverse order.
32823 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
32827 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
32828 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
32829 .cindex "queue" "summary"
32830 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
32831 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
32832 running a command such as
32834 exim -bp | exiqsumm
32836 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
32837 it, as in the following example:
32839 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
32841 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
32842 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
32843 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
32844 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
32846 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
32847 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
32848 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
32849 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
32850 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
32851 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
32854 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
32855 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
32856 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
32857 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
32858 level"& addresses).
32863 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
32865 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
32866 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
32867 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
32868 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
32869 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
32870 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
32871 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
32872 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
32873 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
32874 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
32876 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
32878 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
32880 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
32881 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
32882 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
32884 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
32885 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
32886 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
32887 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
32888 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
32890 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
32891 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
32892 regular expression.
32894 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
32895 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
32897 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
32898 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
32899 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
32902 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
32903 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
32904 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
32905 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
32906 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
32907 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
32908 the &%--help%& option.
32911 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
32912 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32913 .cindex "cycling logs"
32914 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32915 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
32916 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
32917 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
32918 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
32919 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
32920 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
32922 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
32923 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
32925 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
32926 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
32927 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
32931 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
32932 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
32933 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
32934 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
32935 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
32936 logs are handled similarly.
32938 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
32939 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
32940 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
32941 any existing log files.
32943 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
32944 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
32945 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
32946 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
32947 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
32949 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
32951 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
32952 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
32956 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
32957 .cindex "statistics"
32958 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
32959 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
32960 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
32961 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
32962 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
32964 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
32965 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
32966 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
32967 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
32968 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
32970 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
32972 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
32973 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
32974 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
32975 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
32976 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
32977 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
32978 also produced per user.
32980 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
32981 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
32982 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
32983 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
32984 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
32986 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
32987 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
32988 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
32989 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
32990 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
32991 an entirely separate message.
32993 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
32994 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
32995 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
32996 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
32997 least one address that failed.
32999 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
33000 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
33001 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
33002 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
33003 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
33004 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
33005 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
33007 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
33008 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
33009 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
33011 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
33012 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
33013 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
33015 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
33018 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
33019 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
33020 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
33021 .cindex "checking access"
33022 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
33023 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
33024 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
33025 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
33026 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
33027 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
33029 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
33030 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
33032 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
33034 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
33035 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
33036 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
33037 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
33040 550 Relay not permitted
33042 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
33043 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
33044 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
33045 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
33048 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
33049 -f himself@there.example
33051 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
33052 mandatory arguments.
33054 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
33055 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
33056 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
33060 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
33061 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
33062 .cindex "building DBM files"
33063 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
33064 .cindex "lower casing"
33065 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
33066 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
33067 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
33068 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
33069 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
33070 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
33072 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
33073 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
33074 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
33075 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
33078 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
33079 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
33080 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
33084 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
33085 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
33086 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
33087 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
33089 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
33091 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
33092 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
33094 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
33095 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
33096 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
33097 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
33098 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
33099 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
33101 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
33102 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
33103 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
33104 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
33105 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
33106 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
33107 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
33113 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
33114 .cindex "retry" "times"
33115 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
33116 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
33117 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
33118 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
33119 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
33120 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
33121 output. For example:
33123 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
33124 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
33125 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33126 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33127 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
33128 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
33129 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
33130 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
33131 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
33132 past final cutoff time
33134 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
33135 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
33136 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
33137 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
33138 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33139 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33142 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33143 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33144 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33145 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33146 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33147 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33151 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33152 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33153 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33154 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33155 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33156 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33157 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33160 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33162 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33165 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33167 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33169 &'misc'&: other hints data
33172 The &'misc'& database is used for
33175 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33177 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33178 &(smtp)& transport)
33183 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33184 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33185 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33186 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33187 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33189 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33191 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33193 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33194 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33196 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33197 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33198 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33199 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33200 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33201 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33202 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33203 and a textual description of the error.
33205 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33206 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33207 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33210 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33211 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33212 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33213 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33214 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33215 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33220 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33221 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33222 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33223 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33224 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33225 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33226 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33227 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33228 updated sufficiently often.
33230 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33231 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33232 the retry database:
33234 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33236 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33237 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33238 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33239 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33240 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33241 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33242 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33243 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33244 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33245 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33246 whenever it removes information from the database.
33248 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33249 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33250 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33251 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33252 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33254 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33255 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33256 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33257 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33258 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33259 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33260 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33263 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33264 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33269 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33270 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33271 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33272 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33273 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33274 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33275 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33278 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33279 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33280 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33281 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33282 by new data, for example:
33286 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33287 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33288 used as optional separators.
33293 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33294 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33295 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33296 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
33297 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33298 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33299 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33300 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33301 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33302 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33303 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33304 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33305 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33309 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33312 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33315 .vitem &%-interval%&
33316 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33317 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33319 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
33320 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33323 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33326 Suppress verification output.
33328 .vitem &%-retries%&
33329 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33330 the lock (default 10).
33332 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
33333 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33334 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33335 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33338 .vitem &%-timeout%&
33339 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33340 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33341 default), a non-blocking call is used.
33344 Generate verbose output.
33347 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33348 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33349 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33350 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33351 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33352 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33353 more than 30 minutes old.
33355 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33356 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33357 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33358 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33359 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33360 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33362 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33363 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33364 suppresses all output except error messages.
33368 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33370 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33372 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33373 <&'some commands'&>
33376 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33377 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33380 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33381 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33383 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33384 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33388 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33391 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33392 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33393 .cindex "X-windows"
33394 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
33395 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33396 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33397 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33398 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33399 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33400 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33401 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33405 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33406 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33407 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33408 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33409 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33410 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33411 parameters are for.
33413 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33414 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33415 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33417 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33419 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33420 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33421 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33422 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33423 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33425 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33426 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33428 Eximon*background: gray94
33430 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33431 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33432 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33433 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33434 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33435 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33436 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33439 Eximon*highlight: gray
33442 .cindex "admin user"
33443 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33444 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33446 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33447 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33448 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33449 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33450 different parts of the display.
33455 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33456 .cindex "stripchart"
33457 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33458 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33459 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33460 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33461 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33462 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33463 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33464 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33465 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33467 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33468 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33469 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33470 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33472 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33473 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33474 to a single partition.
33476 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33477 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33478 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33479 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33480 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33481 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33482 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33487 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33488 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33489 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33490 .cindex "window size"
33491 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33492 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33493 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33494 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33495 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33496 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33498 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33499 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33500 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33501 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33503 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33504 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33505 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33506 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33507 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33508 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33510 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33511 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33512 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33516 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
33517 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33518 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33519 the main log is maintained.
33520 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33521 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33522 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33523 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33524 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33526 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33527 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33528 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33529 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33530 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33531 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33532 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33533 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33534 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33535 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33536 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33538 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33539 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33540 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33541 It cannot go further back up the log.
33543 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33544 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33545 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33546 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33547 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33548 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33550 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33551 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33552 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33553 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33554 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33555 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33557 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33558 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33559 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33560 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33561 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33562 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33563 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33564 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33565 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33570 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33571 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33572 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33573 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33574 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33575 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33576 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33577 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33578 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33579 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33581 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33582 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33583 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33584 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33585 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33586 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33587 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33589 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33590 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33591 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33592 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33593 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33594 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33595 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33597 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33598 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33599 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33600 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33602 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33603 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33604 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33605 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33606 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33607 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33608 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33611 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33612 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33614 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33615 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33616 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33617 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33618 display is updated.
33622 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33623 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33624 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33625 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33626 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33629 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33630 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33631 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33632 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33633 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33635 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33637 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33641 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33642 in a new text window.
33644 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33645 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33646 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33648 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33649 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33650 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33651 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33653 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33654 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33655 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33656 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33657 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33659 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33660 that the message be frozen.
33662 .cindex "thawing messages"
33663 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
33664 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
33665 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
33666 that the message be thawed.
33668 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
33669 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
33670 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
33671 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
33673 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
33674 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
33677 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
33678 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33679 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33680 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33681 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
33682 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
33683 which case no action is taken.
33685 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
33686 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33687 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33688 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33689 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
33690 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
33691 case no action is taken.
33693 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
33694 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
33696 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
33697 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
33698 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
33699 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
33700 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
33701 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
33702 the address is qualified with that domain.
33705 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
33706 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
33707 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
33708 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
33709 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
33710 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
33711 if no output is generated.
33713 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
33714 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
33715 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
33716 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
33718 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
33719 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
33720 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
33727 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33728 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33730 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
33731 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
33732 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
33733 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
33735 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
33736 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
33737 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
33738 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
33739 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
33740 its security as compared with other MTAs.
33742 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
33743 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
33744 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
33745 as soon as possible.
33748 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
33749 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
33750 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
33751 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
33752 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
33753 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
33756 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
33757 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
33758 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
33759 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
33760 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
33761 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
33763 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
33764 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
33765 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
33766 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
33768 If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for &%-C%&
33769 and &%-D%& only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
33770 also use &%-C%& and &%-D%& and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
33771 the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message
33772 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
33773 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
33774 privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost.
33775 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
33776 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
33778 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
33781 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
33782 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
33783 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
33784 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
33785 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
33791 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
33793 .cindex "root privilege"
33794 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
33795 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
33796 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
33797 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
33798 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
33799 is required for two things:
33802 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
33803 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
33806 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
33807 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
33811 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
33812 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
33813 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
33814 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
33815 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
33816 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
33817 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
33818 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
33820 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
33821 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
33822 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
33824 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
33825 uid and gid in the following cases:
33830 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
33831 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
33832 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
33833 changed to those of the calling process.
33834 However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, only
33835 root callers may use &%-C%& and &%-D%& without losing privilege, and if
33836 DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the &%-D%& option may not be used at all.
33841 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
33842 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
33845 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
33846 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
33847 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
33848 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
33849 testing address verification
33852 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
33855 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
33856 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
33859 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
33862 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
33863 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
33864 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
33865 will be used during message reception.
33867 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
33868 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
33870 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
33871 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
33872 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
33873 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
33874 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
33875 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
33876 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
33877 generating bounce and warning messages.
33879 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
33880 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
33881 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
33882 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
33884 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
33885 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
33891 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
33892 .cindex "privilege, running without"
33893 .cindex "unprivileged running"
33894 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
33895 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
33896 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
33897 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
33898 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
33899 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
33900 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
33904 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
33905 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
33906 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
33907 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
33909 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
33910 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
33911 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
33912 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
33913 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
33915 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
33916 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
33917 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
33920 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
33921 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
33922 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
33924 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
33925 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
33926 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
33927 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
33928 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
33929 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
33930 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
33931 address this problem at this time.
33933 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
33934 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
33935 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
33936 be used in the most straightforward way.
33938 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
33939 number of restrictions on what you can do:
33942 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
33943 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
33944 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
33945 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
33946 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
33948 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
33949 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
33951 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
33952 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
33953 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
33954 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
33956 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
33957 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
33960 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
33961 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
33962 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
33964 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
33965 owned by the Exim user.
33967 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
33968 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
33969 mailboxes need to be created manually.
33974 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
33975 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
33976 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
33977 gives more security at essentially no cost.
33979 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
33980 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
33985 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
33986 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
33987 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
33991 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
33992 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
33993 .cindex "IP source routing"
33994 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
33995 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
33996 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
33997 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
34001 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
34002 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
34003 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
34008 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
34009 .cindex "trusted users"
34010 .cindex "admin user"
34011 .cindex "privileged user"
34012 .cindex "user" "trusted"
34013 .cindex "user" "admin"
34014 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
34015 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
34016 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
34017 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
34018 permit a remote host to be specified.
34021 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
34022 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
34023 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
34024 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
34025 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
34026 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
34028 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
34029 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
34030 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
34031 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
34032 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
34034 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
34035 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
34036 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
34037 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
34038 includes the contents of files on the spool.
34042 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
34043 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
34044 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
34045 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
34046 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
34047 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
34049 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
34050 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
34051 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
34052 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
34053 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
34054 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
34059 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
34060 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
34061 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
34062 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
34063 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
34064 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
34068 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
34069 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
34070 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
34071 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
34072 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
34077 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
34078 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
34079 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
34080 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
34085 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
34086 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
34087 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
34088 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
34089 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
34093 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
34094 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
34095 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
34096 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
34097 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
34098 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
34099 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
34101 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
34102 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
34107 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
34108 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
34109 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
34110 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
34114 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
34115 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
34116 enough to hold the result.
34117 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
34122 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34123 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34125 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
34126 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
34127 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
34128 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
34129 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
34130 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
34131 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
34132 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
34133 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
34134 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
34135 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
34136 themselves are recoverable.
34138 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34139 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34140 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34143 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34144 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34145 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34146 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34147 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34149 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34150 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34151 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34152 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34153 will always be the case.
34155 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34157 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34160 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34162 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34163 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34164 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34165 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34166 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34167 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34168 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34169 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34172 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34173 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34174 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34175 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34176 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34177 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34178 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34179 normally the Exim user.
34181 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34182 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34183 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34184 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34185 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34186 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34187 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34188 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34190 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34191 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34192 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34193 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34195 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34196 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34199 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34200 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34201 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34202 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34203 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34204 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34205 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34206 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34207 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34210 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34211 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34212 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34213 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34214 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34215 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34217 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34218 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34219 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34220 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34221 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34222 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34224 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34225 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34226 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34228 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34229 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34230 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34231 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34232 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34234 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34235 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34236 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34237 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34238 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34240 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34241 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34242 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34244 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34245 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34246 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34248 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34249 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34252 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34253 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34254 present if the number is greater than zero.
34256 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34257 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34258 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34260 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34261 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34262 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34264 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34265 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34268 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34269 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34270 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34273 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34274 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34275 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34276 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34278 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34279 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34280 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34282 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34283 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34284 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34285 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34286 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34287 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34289 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34290 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34291 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34292 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34293 supplied by the remote host, if any.
34295 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34296 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34297 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34298 generated messages.
34301 The message is from a local sender.
34303 .vitem &%-localerror%&
34304 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34306 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34307 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34308 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34309 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34311 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34312 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34313 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34316 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34317 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34320 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34321 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34322 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34324 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34325 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34326 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34328 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34329 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34330 of &$spam_score_int$&.
34332 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34333 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34334 certificate was verified by the server.
34336 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34337 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34338 name of the cipher suite that was used.
34340 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34341 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34342 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34346 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34347 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34348 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34349 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34350 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34351 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34352 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34353 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34354 addresses are complete.
34356 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34357 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34358 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34359 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34360 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34361 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34363 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34364 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34365 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34367 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34368 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34369 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34370 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34374 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34375 darcy@austen.fict.example
34377 alice@wonderland.fict.example
34379 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34380 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34381 line is of the following form:
34383 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34384 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34386 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34387 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34388 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34389 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34390 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34391 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34392 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34393 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34396 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34397 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34398 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34399 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34400 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34404 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34405 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34406 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34407 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34408 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34409 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34410 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34411 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34412 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34413 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34416 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34417 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34418 typical set of headers:
34420 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34421 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34422 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34423 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34424 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34425 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34426 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34427 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34428 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34429 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34430 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34432 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34433 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34434 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34435 .ecindex IIDforspo1
34436 .ecindex IIDforspo2
34437 .ecindex IIDforspo3
34439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34442 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail) - RFC4871" "CHID12" &&&
34446 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
34447 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
34449 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
34451 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
34452 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
34454 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
34455 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
34456 different signature context.
34459 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
34460 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
34461 Exim's standard controls.
34463 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
34464 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
34465 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
34466 signature status. Here is an example:
34468 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM: d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
34470 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
34471 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
34472 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
34473 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
34477 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
34478 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
34480 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
34481 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
34483 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
34485 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
34486 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
34488 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
34490 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
34491 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
34492 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
34493 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
34495 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
34497 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
34498 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
34499 The result can either
34501 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
34503 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
34506 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
34507 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
34511 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
34513 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
34514 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
34515 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
34516 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
34518 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
34520 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
34521 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
34522 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
34523 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
34526 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
34528 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
34529 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
34530 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
34534 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
34535 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
34537 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
34538 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
34539 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
34541 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
34542 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
34543 runtime of the ACL.
34545 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
34546 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
34547 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
34548 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
34550 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
34551 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
34552 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
34553 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-
34554 separated list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
34555 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
34558 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
34560 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
34561 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
34562 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
34564 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
34566 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
34567 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
34568 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. Example:
34570 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
34573 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
34574 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
34577 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
34578 available (from most to least important):
34581 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
34582 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be domain or
34583 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
34584 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
34585 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
34586 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
34588 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
34589 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34591 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
34592 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34594 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
34595 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34597 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
34599 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
34600 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
34601 "fail" or "invalid". One of
34603 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
34604 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
34606 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
34607 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
34609 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
34610 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
34611 means that the message body was modified in transit.
34613 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
34614 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
34615 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
34616 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
34618 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
34619 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
34620 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
34621 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34622 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
34623 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
34624 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
34625 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34626 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
34627 The key record selector string
34628 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
34629 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
34630 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
34631 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34632 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
34633 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34634 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
34635 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
34636 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
34637 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
34638 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
34639 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
34640 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
34641 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
34642 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
34643 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
34644 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
34645 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
34646 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
34647 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
34648 integer size comparisons against this value.
34649 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
34650 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
34651 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
34652 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
34653 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomaining%&
34654 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
34655 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
34656 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34658 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
34659 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34661 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
34662 Notes from the key record (tag n=)
34665 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
34668 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
34669 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
34670 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
34671 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
34672 verb to a group of domains or identities, like:
34675 # Warn when message apparently from GMail has no signature at all
34676 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
34677 sender_domains = gmail.com
34678 dkim_signers = gmail.com
34682 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
34683 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
34684 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
34685 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, like:
34688 deny message = Message from Paypal with invalid or missing signature
34689 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
34690 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
34691 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
34694 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
34695 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
34696 for more information of what they mean.
34699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34702 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
34703 "Adding drivers or lookups"
34704 .cindex "adding drivers"
34705 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
34706 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
34707 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
34708 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
34711 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
34712 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
34714 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
34716 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
34718 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
34719 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
34720 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
34722 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
34724 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
34727 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
34728 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
34730 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
34731 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
34732 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
34734 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
34737 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
34738 as for other drivers and lookups.
34741 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
34742 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
34743 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
34744 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
34745 searched using a binary chop procedure.
34747 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
34748 the interface that is expected.
34753 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34754 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34756 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34757 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
34758 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
34759 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
34761 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34766 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
34767 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
34771 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
34772 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
34773 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
34776 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34777 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////